1 | % texinfo.tex -- TeX macros to handle Texinfo files. |
---|
2 | % |
---|
3 | % Load plain if necessary, i.e., if running under initex. |
---|
4 | \expandafter\ifx\csname fmtname\endcsname\relax\input plain\fi |
---|
5 | % |
---|
6 | \def\texinfoversion{2004-02-25.17} |
---|
7 | % |
---|
8 | % Copyright (C) 1985, 1986, 1988, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, |
---|
9 | % 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004 Free Software |
---|
10 | % Foundation, Inc. |
---|
11 | % |
---|
12 | % This texinfo.tex file is free software; you can redistribute it and/or |
---|
13 | % modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as |
---|
14 | % published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at |
---|
15 | % your option) any later version. |
---|
16 | % |
---|
17 | % This texinfo.tex file is distributed in the hope that it will be |
---|
18 | % useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty |
---|
19 | % of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU |
---|
20 | % General Public License for more details. |
---|
21 | % |
---|
22 | % You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License |
---|
23 | % along with this texinfo.tex file; see the file COPYING. If not, write |
---|
24 | % to the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, |
---|
25 | % Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. |
---|
26 | % |
---|
27 | % As a special exception, when this file is read by TeX when processing |
---|
28 | % a Texinfo source document, you may use the result without |
---|
29 | % restriction. (This has been our intent since Texinfo was invented.) |
---|
30 | % |
---|
31 | % Please try the latest version of texinfo.tex before submitting bug |
---|
32 | % reports; you can get the latest version from: |
---|
33 | % http://www.gnu.org/software/texinfo/ (the Texinfo home page), or |
---|
34 | % ftp://tug.org/tex/texinfo.tex |
---|
35 | % (and all CTAN mirrors, see http://www.ctan.org). |
---|
36 | % The texinfo.tex in any given distribution could well be out |
---|
37 | % of date, so if that's what you're using, please check. |
---|
38 | % |
---|
39 | % Send bug reports to bug-texinfo@gnu.org. Please include including a |
---|
40 | % complete document in each bug report with which we can reproduce the |
---|
41 | % problem. Patches are, of course, greatly appreciated. |
---|
42 | % |
---|
43 | % To process a Texinfo manual with TeX, it's most reliable to use the |
---|
44 | % texi2dvi shell script that comes with the distribution. For a simple |
---|
45 | % manual foo.texi, however, you can get away with this: |
---|
46 | % tex foo.texi |
---|
47 | % texindex foo.?? |
---|
48 | % tex foo.texi |
---|
49 | % tex foo.texi |
---|
50 | % dvips foo.dvi -o # or whatever; this makes foo.ps. |
---|
51 | % The extra TeX runs get the cross-reference information correct. |
---|
52 | % Sometimes one run after texindex suffices, and sometimes you need more |
---|
53 | % than two; texi2dvi does it as many times as necessary. |
---|
54 | % |
---|
55 | % It is possible to adapt texinfo.tex for other languages, to some |
---|
56 | % extent. You can get the existing language-specific files from the |
---|
57 | % full Texinfo distribution. |
---|
58 | % |
---|
59 | % The GNU Texinfo home page is http://www.gnu.org/software/texinfo. |
---|
60 | |
---|
61 | |
---|
62 | \message{Loading texinfo [version \texinfoversion]:} |
---|
63 | |
---|
64 | % If in a .fmt file, print the version number |
---|
65 | % and turn on active characters that we couldn't do earlier because |
---|
66 | % they might have appeared in the input file name. |
---|
67 | \everyjob{\message{[Texinfo version \texinfoversion]}% |
---|
68 | \catcode`+=\active \catcode`\_=\active} |
---|
69 | |
---|
70 | \message{Basics,} |
---|
71 | \chardef\other=12 |
---|
72 | |
---|
73 | % We never want plain's \outer definition of \+ in Texinfo. |
---|
74 | % For @tex, we can use \tabalign. |
---|
75 | \let\+ = \relax |
---|
76 | |
---|
77 | % Save some plain tex macros whose names we will redefine. |
---|
78 | \let\ptexb=\b |
---|
79 | \let\ptexbullet=\bullet |
---|
80 | \let\ptexc=\c |
---|
81 | \let\ptexcomma=\, |
---|
82 | \let\ptexdot=\. |
---|
83 | \let\ptexdots=\dots |
---|
84 | \let\ptexend=\end |
---|
85 | \let\ptexequiv=\equiv |
---|
86 | \let\ptexexclam=\! |
---|
87 | \let\ptexfootnote=\footnote |
---|
88 | \let\ptexgtr=> |
---|
89 | \let\ptexhat=^ |
---|
90 | \let\ptexi=\i |
---|
91 | \let\ptexindent=\indent |
---|
92 | \let\ptexnoindent=\noindent |
---|
93 | \let\ptexinsert=\insert |
---|
94 | \let\ptexlbrace=\{ |
---|
95 | \let\ptexless=< |
---|
96 | \let\ptexplus=+ |
---|
97 | \let\ptexrbrace=\} |
---|
98 | \let\ptexslash=\/ |
---|
99 | \let\ptexstar=\* |
---|
100 | \let\ptext=\t |
---|
101 | |
---|
102 | % If this character appears in an error message or help string, it |
---|
103 | % starts a new line in the output. |
---|
104 | \newlinechar = `^^J |
---|
105 | |
---|
106 | % Use TeX 3.0's \inputlineno to get the line number, for better error |
---|
107 | % messages, but if we're using an old version of TeX, don't do anything. |
---|
108 | % |
---|
109 | \ifx\inputlineno\thisisundefined |
---|
110 | \let\linenumber = \empty % Pre-3.0. |
---|
111 | \else |
---|
112 | \def\linenumber{l.\the\inputlineno:\space} |
---|
113 | \fi |
---|
114 | |
---|
115 | % Set up fixed words for English if not already set. |
---|
116 | \ifx\putwordAppendix\undefined \gdef\putwordAppendix{Appendix}\fi |
---|
117 | \ifx\putwordChapter\undefined \gdef\putwordChapter{Chapter}\fi |
---|
118 | \ifx\putwordfile\undefined \gdef\putwordfile{file}\fi |
---|
119 | \ifx\putwordin\undefined \gdef\putwordin{in}\fi |
---|
120 | \ifx\putwordIndexIsEmpty\undefined \gdef\putwordIndexIsEmpty{(Index is empty)}\fi |
---|
121 | \ifx\putwordIndexNonexistent\undefined \gdef\putwordIndexNonexistent{(Index is nonexistent)}\fi |
---|
122 | \ifx\putwordInfo\undefined \gdef\putwordInfo{Info}\fi |
---|
123 | \ifx\putwordInstanceVariableof\undefined \gdef\putwordInstanceVariableof{Instance Variable of}\fi |
---|
124 | \ifx\putwordMethodon\undefined \gdef\putwordMethodon{Method on}\fi |
---|
125 | \ifx\putwordNoTitle\undefined \gdef\putwordNoTitle{No Title}\fi |
---|
126 | \ifx\putwordof\undefined \gdef\putwordof{of}\fi |
---|
127 | \ifx\putwordon\undefined \gdef\putwordon{on}\fi |
---|
128 | \ifx\putwordpage\undefined \gdef\putwordpage{page}\fi |
---|
129 | \ifx\putwordsection\undefined \gdef\putwordsection{section}\fi |
---|
130 | \ifx\putwordSection\undefined \gdef\putwordSection{Section}\fi |
---|
131 | \ifx\putwordsee\undefined \gdef\putwordsee{see}\fi |
---|
132 | \ifx\putwordSee\undefined \gdef\putwordSee{See}\fi |
---|
133 | \ifx\putwordShortTOC\undefined \gdef\putwordShortTOC{Short Contents}\fi |
---|
134 | \ifx\putwordTOC\undefined \gdef\putwordTOC{Table of Contents}\fi |
---|
135 | % |
---|
136 | \ifx\putwordMJan\undefined \gdef\putwordMJan{January}\fi |
---|
137 | \ifx\putwordMFeb\undefined \gdef\putwordMFeb{February}\fi |
---|
138 | \ifx\putwordMMar\undefined \gdef\putwordMMar{March}\fi |
---|
139 | \ifx\putwordMApr\undefined \gdef\putwordMApr{April}\fi |
---|
140 | \ifx\putwordMMay\undefined \gdef\putwordMMay{May}\fi |
---|
141 | \ifx\putwordMJun\undefined \gdef\putwordMJun{June}\fi |
---|
142 | \ifx\putwordMJul\undefined \gdef\putwordMJul{July}\fi |
---|
143 | \ifx\putwordMAug\undefined \gdef\putwordMAug{August}\fi |
---|
144 | \ifx\putwordMSep\undefined \gdef\putwordMSep{September}\fi |
---|
145 | \ifx\putwordMOct\undefined \gdef\putwordMOct{October}\fi |
---|
146 | \ifx\putwordMNov\undefined \gdef\putwordMNov{November}\fi |
---|
147 | \ifx\putwordMDec\undefined \gdef\putwordMDec{December}\fi |
---|
148 | % |
---|
149 | \ifx\putwordDefmac\undefined \gdef\putwordDefmac{Macro}\fi |
---|
150 | \ifx\putwordDefspec\undefined \gdef\putwordDefspec{Special Form}\fi |
---|
151 | \ifx\putwordDefvar\undefined \gdef\putwordDefvar{Variable}\fi |
---|
152 | \ifx\putwordDefopt\undefined \gdef\putwordDefopt{User Option}\fi |
---|
153 | \ifx\putwordDeffunc\undefined \gdef\putwordDeffunc{Function}\fi |
---|
154 | |
---|
155 | % In some macros, we cannot use the `\? notation---the left quote is |
---|
156 | % in some cases the escape char. |
---|
157 | \chardef\colonChar = `\: |
---|
158 | \chardef\commaChar = `\, |
---|
159 | \chardef\dotChar = `\. |
---|
160 | \chardef\exclamChar= `\! |
---|
161 | \chardef\questChar = `\? |
---|
162 | \chardef\semiChar = `\; |
---|
163 | \chardef\underChar = `\_ |
---|
164 | |
---|
165 | \chardef\spaceChar = `\ % |
---|
166 | \chardef\spacecat = 10 |
---|
167 | \def\spaceisspace{\catcode\spaceChar=\spacecat} |
---|
168 | |
---|
169 | % Ignore a token. |
---|
170 | % |
---|
171 | \def\gobble#1{} |
---|
172 | |
---|
173 | % The following is used inside several \edef's. |
---|
174 | \def\makecsname#1{\expandafter\noexpand\csname#1\endcsname} |
---|
175 | |
---|
176 | % Hyphenation fixes. |
---|
177 | \hyphenation{ |
---|
178 | Flor-i-da Ghost-script Ghost-view Mac-OS ap-pen-dix bit-map bit-maps |
---|
179 | data-base data-bases eshell fall-ing half-way long-est man-u-script |
---|
180 | man-u-scripts mini-buf-fer mini-buf-fers over-view par-a-digm |
---|
181 | par-a-digms rec-tan-gu-lar ro-bot-ics se-vere-ly set-up spa-ces |
---|
182 | stand-alone strong-est time-stamp time-stamps which-ever white-space |
---|
183 | wide-spread wrap-around |
---|
184 | } |
---|
185 | |
---|
186 | % Margin to add to right of even pages, to left of odd pages. |
---|
187 | \newdimen\bindingoffset |
---|
188 | \newdimen\normaloffset |
---|
189 | \newdimen\pagewidth \newdimen\pageheight |
---|
190 | |
---|
191 | % For a final copy, take out the rectangles |
---|
192 | % that mark overfull boxes (in case you have decided |
---|
193 | % that the text looks ok even though it passes the margin). |
---|
194 | % |
---|
195 | \def\finalout{\overfullrule=0pt} |
---|
196 | |
---|
197 | % @| inserts a changebar to the left of the current line. It should |
---|
198 | % surround any changed text. This approach does *not* work if the |
---|
199 | % change spans more than two lines of output. To handle that, we would |
---|
200 | % have adopt a much more difficult approach (putting marks into the main |
---|
201 | % vertical list for the beginning and end of each change). |
---|
202 | % |
---|
203 | \def\|{% |
---|
204 | % \vadjust can only be used in horizontal mode. |
---|
205 | \leavevmode |
---|
206 | % |
---|
207 | % Append this vertical mode material after the current line in the output. |
---|
208 | \vadjust{% |
---|
209 | % We want to insert a rule with the height and depth of the current |
---|
210 | % leading; that is exactly what \strutbox is supposed to record. |
---|
211 | \vskip-\baselineskip |
---|
212 | % |
---|
213 | % \vadjust-items are inserted at the left edge of the type. So |
---|
214 | % the \llap here moves out into the left-hand margin. |
---|
215 | \llap{% |
---|
216 | % |
---|
217 | % For a thicker or thinner bar, change the `1pt'. |
---|
218 | \vrule height\baselineskip width1pt |
---|
219 | % |
---|
220 | % This is the space between the bar and the text. |
---|
221 | \hskip 12pt |
---|
222 | }% |
---|
223 | }% |
---|
224 | } |
---|
225 | |
---|
226 | % Sometimes it is convenient to have everything in the transcript file |
---|
227 | % and nothing on the terminal. We don't just call \tracingall here, |
---|
228 | % since that produces some useless output on the terminal. We also make |
---|
229 | % some effort to order the tracing commands to reduce output in the log |
---|
230 | % file; cf. trace.sty in LaTeX. |
---|
231 | % |
---|
232 | \def\gloggingall{\begingroup \globaldefs = 1 \loggingall \endgroup}% |
---|
233 | \def\loggingall{% |
---|
234 | \tracingstats2 |
---|
235 | \tracingpages1 |
---|
236 | \tracinglostchars2 % 2 gives us more in etex |
---|
237 | \tracingparagraphs1 |
---|
238 | \tracingoutput1 |
---|
239 | \tracingmacros2 |
---|
240 | \tracingrestores1 |
---|
241 | \showboxbreadth\maxdimen \showboxdepth\maxdimen |
---|
242 | \ifx\eTeXversion\undefined\else % etex gives us more logging |
---|
243 | \tracingscantokens1 |
---|
244 | \tracingifs1 |
---|
245 | \tracinggroups1 |
---|
246 | \tracingnesting2 |
---|
247 | \tracingassigns1 |
---|
248 | \fi |
---|
249 | \tracingcommands3 % 3 gives us more in etex |
---|
250 | \errorcontextlines16 |
---|
251 | }% |
---|
252 | |
---|
253 | % add check for \lastpenalty to plain's definitions. If the last thing |
---|
254 | % we did was a \nobreak, we don't want to insert more space. |
---|
255 | % |
---|
256 | \def\smallbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\smallskipamount |
---|
257 | \removelastskip\penalty-50\smallskip\fi\fi} |
---|
258 | \def\medbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\medskipamount |
---|
259 | \removelastskip\penalty-100\medskip\fi\fi} |
---|
260 | \def\bigbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\bigskipamount |
---|
261 | \removelastskip\penalty-200\bigskip\fi\fi} |
---|
262 | |
---|
263 | % For @cropmarks command. |
---|
264 | % Do @cropmarks to get crop marks. |
---|
265 | % |
---|
266 | \newif\ifcropmarks |
---|
267 | \let\cropmarks = \cropmarkstrue |
---|
268 | % |
---|
269 | % Dimensions to add cropmarks at corners. |
---|
270 | % Added by P. A. MacKay, 12 Nov. 1986 |
---|
271 | % |
---|
272 | \newdimen\outerhsize \newdimen\outervsize % set by the paper size routines |
---|
273 | \newdimen\cornerlong \cornerlong=1pc |
---|
274 | \newdimen\cornerthick \cornerthick=.3pt |
---|
275 | \newdimen\topandbottommargin \topandbottommargin=.75in |
---|
276 | |
---|
277 | % Main output routine. |
---|
278 | \chardef\PAGE = 255 |
---|
279 | \output = {\onepageout{\pagecontents\PAGE}} |
---|
280 | |
---|
281 | \newbox\headlinebox |
---|
282 | \newbox\footlinebox |
---|
283 | |
---|
284 | % \onepageout takes a vbox as an argument. Note that \pagecontents |
---|
285 | % does insertions, but you have to call it yourself. |
---|
286 | \def\onepageout#1{% |
---|
287 | \ifcropmarks \hoffset=0pt \else \hoffset=\normaloffset \fi |
---|
288 | % |
---|
289 | \ifodd\pageno \advance\hoffset by \bindingoffset |
---|
290 | \else \advance\hoffset by -\bindingoffset\fi |
---|
291 | % |
---|
292 | % Do this outside of the \shipout so @code etc. will be expanded in |
---|
293 | % the headline as they should be, not taken literally (outputting ''code). |
---|
294 | \setbox\headlinebox = \vbox{\let\hsize=\pagewidth \makeheadline}% |
---|
295 | \setbox\footlinebox = \vbox{\let\hsize=\pagewidth \makefootline}% |
---|
296 | % |
---|
297 | {% |
---|
298 | % Have to do this stuff outside the \shipout because we want it to |
---|
299 | % take effect in \write's, yet the group defined by the \vbox ends |
---|
300 | % before the \shipout runs. |
---|
301 | % |
---|
302 | \escapechar = `\\ % use backslash in output files. |
---|
303 | \indexdummies % don't expand commands in the output. |
---|
304 | \normalturnoffactive % \ in index entries must not stay \, e.g., if |
---|
305 | % the page break happens to be in the middle of an example. |
---|
306 | \shipout\vbox{% |
---|
307 | % Do this early so pdf references go to the beginning of the page. |
---|
308 | \ifpdfmakepagedest \pdfdest name{\the\pageno} xyz\fi |
---|
309 | % |
---|
310 | \ifcropmarks \vbox to \outervsize\bgroup |
---|
311 | \hsize = \outerhsize |
---|
312 | \vskip-\topandbottommargin |
---|
313 | \vtop to0pt{% |
---|
314 | \line{\ewtop\hfil\ewtop}% |
---|
315 | \nointerlineskip |
---|
316 | \line{% |
---|
317 | \vbox{\moveleft\cornerthick\nstop}% |
---|
318 | \hfill |
---|
319 | \vbox{\moveright\cornerthick\nstop}% |
---|
320 | }% |
---|
321 | \vss}% |
---|
322 | \vskip\topandbottommargin |
---|
323 | \line\bgroup |
---|
324 | \hfil % center the page within the outer (page) hsize. |
---|
325 | \ifodd\pageno\hskip\bindingoffset\fi |
---|
326 | \vbox\bgroup |
---|
327 | \fi |
---|
328 | % |
---|
329 | \unvbox\headlinebox |
---|
330 | \pagebody{#1}% |
---|
331 | \ifdim\ht\footlinebox > 0pt |
---|
332 | % Only leave this space if the footline is nonempty. |
---|
333 | % (We lessened \vsize for it in \oddfootingxxx.) |
---|
334 | % The \baselineskip=24pt in plain's \makefootline has no effect. |
---|
335 | \vskip 2\baselineskip |
---|
336 | \unvbox\footlinebox |
---|
337 | \fi |
---|
338 | % |
---|
339 | \ifcropmarks |
---|
340 | \egroup % end of \vbox\bgroup |
---|
341 | \hfil\egroup % end of (centering) \line\bgroup |
---|
342 | \vskip\topandbottommargin plus1fill minus1fill |
---|
343 | \boxmaxdepth = \cornerthick |
---|
344 | \vbox to0pt{\vss |
---|
345 | \line{% |
---|
346 | \vbox{\moveleft\cornerthick\nsbot}% |
---|
347 | \hfill |
---|
348 | \vbox{\moveright\cornerthick\nsbot}% |
---|
349 | }% |
---|
350 | \nointerlineskip |
---|
351 | \line{\ewbot\hfil\ewbot}% |
---|
352 | }% |
---|
353 | \egroup % \vbox from first cropmarks clause |
---|
354 | \fi |
---|
355 | }% end of \shipout\vbox |
---|
356 | }% end of group with \normalturnoffactive |
---|
357 | \advancepageno |
---|
358 | \ifnum\outputpenalty>-20000 \else\dosupereject\fi |
---|
359 | } |
---|
360 | |
---|
361 | \newinsert\margin \dimen\margin=\maxdimen |
---|
362 | |
---|
363 | \def\pagebody#1{\vbox to\pageheight{\boxmaxdepth=\maxdepth #1}} |
---|
364 | {\catcode`\@ =11 |
---|
365 | \gdef\pagecontents#1{\ifvoid\topins\else\unvbox\topins\fi |
---|
366 | % marginal hacks, juha@viisa.uucp (Juha Takala) |
---|
367 | \ifvoid\margin\else % marginal info is present |
---|
368 | \rlap{\kern\hsize\vbox to\z@{\kern1pt\box\margin \vss}}\fi |
---|
369 | \dimen@=\dp#1 \unvbox#1 |
---|
370 | \ifvoid\footins\else\vskip\skip\footins\footnoterule \unvbox\footins\fi |
---|
371 | \ifr@ggedbottom \kern-\dimen@ \vfil \fi} |
---|
372 | } |
---|
373 | |
---|
374 | % Here are the rules for the cropmarks. Note that they are |
---|
375 | % offset so that the space between them is truly \outerhsize or \outervsize |
---|
376 | % (P. A. MacKay, 12 November, 1986) |
---|
377 | % |
---|
378 | \def\ewtop{\vrule height\cornerthick depth0pt width\cornerlong} |
---|
379 | \def\nstop{\vbox |
---|
380 | {\hrule height\cornerthick depth\cornerlong width\cornerthick}} |
---|
381 | \def\ewbot{\vrule height0pt depth\cornerthick width\cornerlong} |
---|
382 | \def\nsbot{\vbox |
---|
383 | {\hrule height\cornerlong depth\cornerthick width\cornerthick}} |
---|
384 | |
---|
385 | % Parse an argument, then pass it to #1. The argument is the rest of |
---|
386 | % the input line (except we remove a trailing comment). #1 should be a |
---|
387 | % macro which expects an ordinary undelimited TeX argument. |
---|
388 | % |
---|
389 | \def\parsearg{\parseargusing{}} |
---|
390 | \def\parseargusing#1#2{% |
---|
391 | \def\next{#2}% |
---|
392 | \begingroup |
---|
393 | \obeylines |
---|
394 | \spaceisspace |
---|
395 | #1% |
---|
396 | \parseargline\empty% Insert the \empty token, see \finishparsearg below. |
---|
397 | } |
---|
398 | |
---|
399 | {\obeylines % |
---|
400 | \gdef\parseargline#1^^M{% |
---|
401 | \endgroup % End of the group started in \parsearg. |
---|
402 | \argremovecomment #1\comment\ArgTerm% |
---|
403 | }% |
---|
404 | } |
---|
405 | |
---|
406 | % First remove any @comment, then any @c comment. |
---|
407 | \def\argremovecomment#1\comment#2\ArgTerm{\argremovec #1\c\ArgTerm} |
---|
408 | \def\argremovec#1\c#2\ArgTerm{\argcheckspaces#1\^^M\ArgTerm} |
---|
409 | |
---|
410 | % Each occurence of `\^^M' or `<space>\^^M' is replaced by a single space. |
---|
411 | % |
---|
412 | % \argremovec might leave us with trailing space, e.g., |
---|
413 | % @end itemize @c foo |
---|
414 | % This space token undergoes the same procedure and is eventually removed |
---|
415 | % by \finishparsearg. |
---|
416 | % |
---|
417 | \def\argcheckspaces#1\^^M{\argcheckspacesX#1\^^M \^^M} |
---|
418 | \def\argcheckspacesX#1 \^^M{\argcheckspacesY#1\^^M} |
---|
419 | \def\argcheckspacesY#1\^^M#2\^^M#3\ArgTerm{% |
---|
420 | \def\temp{#3}% |
---|
421 | \ifx\temp\empty |
---|
422 | % We cannot use \next here, as it holds the macro to run; |
---|
423 | % thus we reuse \temp. |
---|
424 | \let\temp\finishparsearg |
---|
425 | \else |
---|
426 | \let\temp\argcheckspaces |
---|
427 | \fi |
---|
428 | % Put the space token in: |
---|
429 | \temp#1 #3\ArgTerm |
---|
430 | } |
---|
431 | |
---|
432 | % If a _delimited_ argument is enclosed in braces, they get stripped; so |
---|
433 | % to get _exactly_ the rest of the line, we had to prevent such situation. |
---|
434 | % We prepended an \empty token at the very beginning and we expand it now, |
---|
435 | % just before passing the control to \next. |
---|
436 | % (Similarily, we have to think about #3 of \argcheckspacesY above: it is |
---|
437 | % either the null string, or it ends with \^^M---thus there is no danger |
---|
438 | % that a pair of braces would be stripped. |
---|
439 | % |
---|
440 | % But first, we have to remove the trailing space token. |
---|
441 | % |
---|
442 | \def\finishparsearg#1 \ArgTerm{\expandafter\next\expandafter{#1}} |
---|
443 | |
---|
444 | % \parseargdef\foo{...} |
---|
445 | % is roughly equivalent to |
---|
446 | % \def\foo{\parsearg\Xfoo} |
---|
447 | % \def\Xfoo#1{...} |
---|
448 | % |
---|
449 | % Actually, I use \csname\string\foo\endcsname, ie. \\foo, as it is my |
---|
450 | % favourite TeX trick. --kasal, 16nov03 |
---|
451 | |
---|
452 | \def\parseargdef#1{% |
---|
453 | \expandafter \doparseargdef \csname\string#1\endcsname #1% |
---|
454 | } |
---|
455 | \def\doparseargdef#1#2{% |
---|
456 | \def#2{\parsearg#1}% |
---|
457 | \def#1##1% |
---|
458 | } |
---|
459 | |
---|
460 | % Several utility definitions with active space: |
---|
461 | { |
---|
462 | \obeyspaces |
---|
463 | \gdef\obeyedspace{ } |
---|
464 | |
---|
465 | % Make each space character in the input produce a normal interword |
---|
466 | % space in the output. Don't allow a line break at this space, as this |
---|
467 | % is used only in environments like @example, where each line of input |
---|
468 | % should produce a line of output anyway. |
---|
469 | % |
---|
470 | \gdef\sepspaces{\obeyspaces\let =\tie} |
---|
471 | |
---|
472 | % If an index command is used in an @example environment, any spaces |
---|
473 | % therein should become regular spaces in the raw index file, not the |
---|
474 | % expansion of \tie (\leavevmode \penalty \@M \ ). |
---|
475 | \gdef\unsepspaces{\let =\space} |
---|
476 | } |
---|
477 | |
---|
478 | |
---|
479 | \def\flushcr{\ifx\par\lisppar \def\next##1{}\else \let\next=\relax \fi \next} |
---|
480 | |
---|
481 | % Define the framework for environments in texinfo.tex. It's used like this: |
---|
482 | % |
---|
483 | % \envdef\foo{...} |
---|
484 | % \def\Efoo{...} |
---|
485 | % |
---|
486 | % It's the responsibility of \envdef to insert \begingroup before the |
---|
487 | % actual body; @end closes the group after calling \Efoo. \envdef also |
---|
488 | % defines \thisenv, so the current environment is known; @end checks |
---|
489 | % whether the environment name matches. The \checkenv macro can also be |
---|
490 | % used to check whether the current environment is the one expected. |
---|
491 | % |
---|
492 | % Non-false conditionals (@iftex, @ifset) don't fit into this, so they |
---|
493 | % are not treated as enviroments; they don't open a group. (The |
---|
494 | % implementation of @end takes care not to call \endgroup in this |
---|
495 | % special case.) |
---|
496 | |
---|
497 | |
---|
498 | % At runtime, environments start with this: |
---|
499 | \def\startenvironment#1{\begingroup\def\thisenv{#1}} |
---|
500 | % initialize |
---|
501 | \let\thisenv\empty |
---|
502 | |
---|
503 | % ... but they get defined via ``\envdef\foo{...}'': |
---|
504 | \long\def\envdef#1#2{\def#1{\startenvironment#1#2}} |
---|
505 | \def\envparseargdef#1#2{\parseargdef#1{\startenvironment#1#2}} |
---|
506 | |
---|
507 | % Check whether we're in the right environment: |
---|
508 | \def\checkenv#1{% |
---|
509 | \def\temp{#1}% |
---|
510 | \ifx\thisenv\temp |
---|
511 | \else |
---|
512 | \badenverr |
---|
513 | \fi |
---|
514 | } |
---|
515 | |
---|
516 | % Evironment mismatch, #1 expected: |
---|
517 | \def\badenverr{% |
---|
518 | \errhelp = \EMsimple |
---|
519 | \errmessage{This command can appear only \inenvironment\temp, |
---|
520 | not \inenvironment\thisenv}% |
---|
521 | } |
---|
522 | \def\inenvironment#1{% |
---|
523 | \ifx#1\empty |
---|
524 | out of any environment% |
---|
525 | \else |
---|
526 | in environment \expandafter\string#1% |
---|
527 | \fi |
---|
528 | } |
---|
529 | |
---|
530 | % @end foo executes the definition of \Efoo. |
---|
531 | % But first, it executes a specialized version of \checkenv |
---|
532 | % |
---|
533 | \parseargdef\end{% |
---|
534 | \if 1\csname iscond.#1\endcsname |
---|
535 | \else |
---|
536 | % The general wording of \badenverr may not be ideal, but... --kasal, 06nov03 |
---|
537 | \expandafter\checkenv\csname#1\endcsname |
---|
538 | \csname E#1\endcsname |
---|
539 | \endgroup |
---|
540 | \fi |
---|
541 | } |
---|
542 | |
---|
543 | \newhelp\EMsimple{Press RETURN to continue.} |
---|
544 | |
---|
545 | |
---|
546 | %% Simple single-character @ commands |
---|
547 | |
---|
548 | % @@ prints an @ |
---|
549 | % Kludge this until the fonts are right (grr). |
---|
550 | \def\@{{\tt\char64}} |
---|
551 | |
---|
552 | % This is turned off because it was never documented |
---|
553 | % and you can use @w{...} around a quote to suppress ligatures. |
---|
554 | %% Define @` and @' to be the same as ` and ' |
---|
555 | %% but suppressing ligatures. |
---|
556 | %\def\`{{`}} |
---|
557 | %\def\'{{'}} |
---|
558 | |
---|
559 | % Used to generate quoted braces. |
---|
560 | \def\mylbrace {{\tt\char123}} |
---|
561 | \def\myrbrace {{\tt\char125}} |
---|
562 | \let\{=\mylbrace |
---|
563 | \let\}=\myrbrace |
---|
564 | \begingroup |
---|
565 | % Definitions to produce \{ and \} commands for indices, |
---|
566 | % and @{ and @} for the aux file. |
---|
567 | \catcode`\{ = \other \catcode`\} = \other |
---|
568 | \catcode`\[ = 1 \catcode`\] = 2 |
---|
569 | \catcode`\! = 0 \catcode`\\ = \other |
---|
570 | !gdef!lbracecmd[\{]% |
---|
571 | !gdef!rbracecmd[\}]% |
---|
572 | !gdef!lbraceatcmd[@{]% |
---|
573 | !gdef!rbraceatcmd[@}]% |
---|
574 | !endgroup |
---|
575 | |
---|
576 | % @comma{} to avoid , parsing problems. |
---|
577 | \let\comma = , |
---|
578 | |
---|
579 | % Accents: @, @dotaccent @ringaccent @ubaraccent @udotaccent |
---|
580 | % Others are defined by plain TeX: @` @' @" @^ @~ @= @u @v @H. |
---|
581 | \let\, = \c |
---|
582 | \let\dotaccent = \. |
---|
583 | \def\ringaccent#1{{\accent23 #1}} |
---|
584 | \let\tieaccent = \t |
---|
585 | \let\ubaraccent = \b |
---|
586 | \let\udotaccent = \d |
---|
587 | |
---|
588 | % Other special characters: @questiondown @exclamdown @ordf @ordm |
---|
589 | % Plain TeX defines: @AA @AE @O @OE @L (plus lowercase versions) @ss. |
---|
590 | \def\questiondown{?`} |
---|
591 | \def\exclamdown{!`} |
---|
592 | \def\ordf{\leavevmode\raise1ex\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize \underbar{a}}} |
---|
593 | \def\ordm{\leavevmode\raise1ex\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize \underbar{o}}} |
---|
594 | |
---|
595 | % Dotless i and dotless j, used for accents. |
---|
596 | \def\imacro{i} |
---|
597 | \def\jmacro{j} |
---|
598 | \def\dotless#1{% |
---|
599 | \def\temp{#1}% |
---|
600 | \ifx\temp\imacro \ptexi |
---|
601 | \else\ifx\temp\jmacro \j |
---|
602 | \else \errmessage{@dotless can be used only with i or j}% |
---|
603 | \fi\fi |
---|
604 | } |
---|
605 | |
---|
606 | % The \TeX{} logo, as in plain, but resetting the spacing so that a |
---|
607 | % period following counts as ending a sentence. (Idea found in latex.) |
---|
608 | % |
---|
609 | \edef\TeX{\TeX \spacefactor=3000 } |
---|
610 | |
---|
611 | % @LaTeX{} logo. Not quite the same results as the definition in |
---|
612 | % latex.ltx, since we use a different font for the raised A; it's most |
---|
613 | % convenient for us to use an explicitly smaller font, rather than using |
---|
614 | % the \scriptstyle font (since we don't reset \scriptstyle and |
---|
615 | % \scriptscriptstyle). |
---|
616 | % |
---|
617 | \def\LaTeX{% |
---|
618 | L\kern-.36em |
---|
619 | {\setbox0=\hbox{T}% |
---|
620 | \vbox to \ht0{\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize A}\vss}}% |
---|
621 | \kern-.15em |
---|
622 | \TeX |
---|
623 | } |
---|
624 | |
---|
625 | % Be sure we're in horizontal mode when doing a tie, since we make space |
---|
626 | % equivalent to this in @example-like environments. Otherwise, a space |
---|
627 | % at the beginning of a line will start with \penalty -- and |
---|
628 | % since \penalty is valid in vertical mode, we'd end up putting the |
---|
629 | % penalty on the vertical list instead of in the new paragraph. |
---|
630 | {\catcode`@ = 11 |
---|
631 | % Avoid using \@M directly, because that causes trouble |
---|
632 | % if the definition is written into an index file. |
---|
633 | \global\let\tiepenalty = \@M |
---|
634 | \gdef\tie{\leavevmode\penalty\tiepenalty\ } |
---|
635 | } |
---|
636 | |
---|
637 | % @: forces normal size whitespace following. |
---|
638 | \def\:{\spacefactor=1000 } |
---|
639 | |
---|
640 | % @* forces a line break. |
---|
641 | \def\*{\hfil\break\hbox{}\ignorespaces} |
---|
642 | |
---|
643 | % @/ allows a line break. |
---|
644 | \let\/=\allowbreak |
---|
645 | |
---|
646 | % @. is an end-of-sentence period. |
---|
647 | \def\.{.\spacefactor=3000 } |
---|
648 | |
---|
649 | % @! is an end-of-sentence bang. |
---|
650 | \def\!{!\spacefactor=3000 } |
---|
651 | |
---|
652 | % @? is an end-of-sentence query. |
---|
653 | \def\?{?\spacefactor=3000 } |
---|
654 | |
---|
655 | % @w prevents a word break. Without the \leavevmode, @w at the |
---|
656 | % beginning of a paragraph, when TeX is still in vertical mode, would |
---|
657 | % produce a whole line of output instead of starting the paragraph. |
---|
658 | \def\w#1{\leavevmode\hbox{#1}} |
---|
659 | |
---|
660 | % @group ... @end group forces ... to be all on one page, by enclosing |
---|
661 | % it in a TeX vbox. We use \vtop instead of \vbox to construct the box |
---|
662 | % to keep its height that of a normal line. According to the rules for |
---|
663 | % \topskip (p.114 of the TeXbook), the glue inserted is |
---|
664 | % max (\topskip - \ht (first item), 0). If that height is large, |
---|
665 | % therefore, no glue is inserted, and the space between the headline and |
---|
666 | % the text is small, which looks bad. |
---|
667 | % |
---|
668 | % Another complication is that the group might be very large. This can |
---|
669 | % cause the glue on the previous page to be unduly stretched, because it |
---|
670 | % does not have much material. In this case, it's better to add an |
---|
671 | % explicit \vfill so that the extra space is at the bottom. The |
---|
672 | % threshold for doing this is if the group is more than \vfilllimit |
---|
673 | % percent of a page (\vfilllimit can be changed inside of @tex). |
---|
674 | % |
---|
675 | \newbox\groupbox |
---|
676 | \def\vfilllimit{0.7} |
---|
677 | % |
---|
678 | \envdef\group{% |
---|
679 | \ifnum\catcode`\^^M=\active \else |
---|
680 | \errhelp = \groupinvalidhelp |
---|
681 | \errmessage{@group invalid in context where filling is enabled}% |
---|
682 | \fi |
---|
683 | \startsavinginserts |
---|
684 | % |
---|
685 | \setbox\groupbox = \vtop\bgroup |
---|
686 | % Do @comment since we are called inside an environment such as |
---|
687 | % @example, where each end-of-line in the input causes an |
---|
688 | % end-of-line in the output. We don't want the end-of-line after |
---|
689 | % the `@group' to put extra space in the output. Since @group |
---|
690 | % should appear on a line by itself (according to the Texinfo |
---|
691 | % manual), we don't worry about eating any user text. |
---|
692 | \comment |
---|
693 | } |
---|
694 | % |
---|
695 | % The \vtop produces a box with normal height and large depth; thus, TeX puts |
---|
696 | % \baselineskip glue before it, and (when the next line of text is done) |
---|
697 | % \lineskip glue after it. Thus, space below is not quite equal to space |
---|
698 | % above. But it's pretty close. |
---|
699 | \def\Egroup{% |
---|
700 | % To get correct interline space between the last line of the group |
---|
701 | % and the first line afterwards, we have to propagate \prevdepth. |
---|
702 | \endgraf % Not \par, as it may have been set to \lisppar. |
---|
703 | \global\dimen1 = \prevdepth |
---|
704 | \egroup % End the \vtop. |
---|
705 | % \dimen0 is the vertical size of the group's box. |
---|
706 | \dimen0 = \ht\groupbox \advance\dimen0 by \dp\groupbox |
---|
707 | % \dimen2 is how much space is left on the page (more or less). |
---|
708 | \dimen2 = \pageheight \advance\dimen2 by -\pagetotal |
---|
709 | % if the group doesn't fit on the current page, and it's a big big |
---|
710 | % group, force a page break. |
---|
711 | \ifdim \dimen0 > \dimen2 |
---|
712 | \ifdim \pagetotal < \vfilllimit\pageheight |
---|
713 | \page |
---|
714 | \fi |
---|
715 | \fi |
---|
716 | \box\groupbox |
---|
717 | \prevdepth = \dimen1 |
---|
718 | \checkinserts |
---|
719 | } |
---|
720 | % |
---|
721 | % TeX puts in an \escapechar (i.e., `@') at the beginning of the help |
---|
722 | % message, so this ends up printing `@group can only ...'. |
---|
723 | % |
---|
724 | \newhelp\groupinvalidhelp{% |
---|
725 | group can only be used in environments such as @example,^^J% |
---|
726 | where each line of input produces a line of output.} |
---|
727 | |
---|
728 | % @need space-in-mils |
---|
729 | % forces a page break if there is not space-in-mils remaining. |
---|
730 | |
---|
731 | \newdimen\mil \mil=0.001in |
---|
732 | |
---|
733 | % Old definition--didn't work. |
---|
734 | %\parseargdef\need{\par % |
---|
735 | %% This method tries to make TeX break the page naturally |
---|
736 | %% if the depth of the box does not fit. |
---|
737 | %{\baselineskip=0pt% |
---|
738 | %\vtop to #1\mil{\vfil}\kern -#1\mil\nobreak |
---|
739 | %\prevdepth=-1000pt |
---|
740 | %}} |
---|
741 | |
---|
742 | \parseargdef\need{% |
---|
743 | % Ensure vertical mode, so we don't make a big box in the middle of a |
---|
744 | % paragraph. |
---|
745 | \par |
---|
746 | % |
---|
747 | % If the @need value is less than one line space, it's useless. |
---|
748 | \dimen0 = #1\mil |
---|
749 | \dimen2 = \ht\strutbox |
---|
750 | \advance\dimen2 by \dp\strutbox |
---|
751 | \ifdim\dimen0 > \dimen2 |
---|
752 | % |
---|
753 | % Do a \strut just to make the height of this box be normal, so the |
---|
754 | % normal leading is inserted relative to the preceding line. |
---|
755 | % And a page break here is fine. |
---|
756 | \vtop to #1\mil{\strut\vfil}% |
---|
757 | % |
---|
758 | % TeX does not even consider page breaks if a penalty added to the |
---|
759 | % main vertical list is 10000 or more. But in order to see if the |
---|
760 | % empty box we just added fits on the page, we must make it consider |
---|
761 | % page breaks. On the other hand, we don't want to actually break the |
---|
762 | % page after the empty box. So we use a penalty of 9999. |
---|
763 | % |
---|
764 | % There is an extremely small chance that TeX will actually break the |
---|
765 | % page at this \penalty, if there are no other feasible breakpoints in |
---|
766 | % sight. (If the user is using lots of big @group commands, which |
---|
767 | % almost-but-not-quite fill up a page, TeX will have a hard time doing |
---|
768 | % good page breaking, for example.) However, I could not construct an |
---|
769 | % example where a page broke at this \penalty; if it happens in a real |
---|
770 | % document, then we can reconsider our strategy. |
---|
771 | \penalty9999 |
---|
772 | % |
---|
773 | % Back up by the size of the box, whether we did a page break or not. |
---|
774 | \kern -#1\mil |
---|
775 | % |
---|
776 | % Do not allow a page break right after this kern. |
---|
777 | \nobreak |
---|
778 | \fi |
---|
779 | } |
---|
780 | |
---|
781 | % @br forces paragraph break (and is undocumented). |
---|
782 | |
---|
783 | \let\br = \par |
---|
784 | |
---|
785 | % @page forces the start of a new page. |
---|
786 | % |
---|
787 | \def\page{\par\vfill\supereject} |
---|
788 | |
---|
789 | % @exdent text.... |
---|
790 | % outputs text on separate line in roman font, starting at standard page margin |
---|
791 | |
---|
792 | % This records the amount of indent in the innermost environment. |
---|
793 | % That's how much \exdent should take out. |
---|
794 | \newskip\exdentamount |
---|
795 | |
---|
796 | % This defn is used inside fill environments such as @defun. |
---|
797 | \parseargdef\exdent{\hfil\break\hbox{\kern -\exdentamount{\rm#1}}\hfil\break} |
---|
798 | |
---|
799 | % This defn is used inside nofill environments such as @example. |
---|
800 | \parseargdef\nofillexdent{{\advance \leftskip by -\exdentamount |
---|
801 | \leftline{\hskip\leftskip{\rm#1}}}} |
---|
802 | |
---|
803 | % @inmargin{WHICH}{TEXT} puts TEXT in the WHICH margin next to the current |
---|
804 | % paragraph. For more general purposes, use the \margin insertion |
---|
805 | % class. WHICH is `l' or `r'. |
---|
806 | % |
---|
807 | \newskip\inmarginspacing \inmarginspacing=1cm |
---|
808 | \def\strutdepth{\dp\strutbox} |
---|
809 | % |
---|
810 | \def\doinmargin#1#2{\strut\vadjust{% |
---|
811 | \nobreak |
---|
812 | \kern-\strutdepth |
---|
813 | \vtop to \strutdepth{% |
---|
814 | \baselineskip=\strutdepth |
---|
815 | \vss |
---|
816 | % if you have multiple lines of stuff to put here, you'll need to |
---|
817 | % make the vbox yourself of the appropriate size. |
---|
818 | \ifx#1l% |
---|
819 | \llap{\ignorespaces #2\hskip\inmarginspacing}% |
---|
820 | \else |
---|
821 | \rlap{\hskip\hsize \hskip\inmarginspacing \ignorespaces #2}% |
---|
822 | \fi |
---|
823 | \null |
---|
824 | }% |
---|
825 | }} |
---|
826 | \def\inleftmargin{\doinmargin l} |
---|
827 | \def\inrightmargin{\doinmargin r} |
---|
828 | % |
---|
829 | % @inmargin{TEXT [, RIGHT-TEXT]} |
---|
830 | % (if RIGHT-TEXT is given, use TEXT for left page, RIGHT-TEXT for right; |
---|
831 | % else use TEXT for both). |
---|
832 | % |
---|
833 | \def\inmargin#1{\parseinmargin #1,,\finish} |
---|
834 | \def\parseinmargin#1,#2,#3\finish{% not perfect, but better than nothing. |
---|
835 | \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}% |
---|
836 | \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt |
---|
837 | \def\lefttext{#1}% have both texts |
---|
838 | \def\righttext{#2}% |
---|
839 | \else |
---|
840 | \def\lefttext{#1}% have only one text |
---|
841 | \def\righttext{#1}% |
---|
842 | \fi |
---|
843 | % |
---|
844 | \ifodd\pageno |
---|
845 | \def\temp{\inrightmargin\righttext}% odd page -> outside is right margin |
---|
846 | \else |
---|
847 | \def\temp{\inleftmargin\lefttext}% |
---|
848 | \fi |
---|
849 | \temp |
---|
850 | } |
---|
851 | |
---|
852 | % @include file insert text of that file as input. |
---|
853 | % |
---|
854 | \def\include{\parseargusing\filenamecatcodes\includezzz} |
---|
855 | \def\includezzz#1{% |
---|
856 | \pushthisfilestack |
---|
857 | \def\thisfile{#1}% |
---|
858 | {% |
---|
859 | \makevalueexpandable |
---|
860 | \def\temp{\input #1 }% |
---|
861 | \expandafter |
---|
862 | }\temp |
---|
863 | \popthisfilestack |
---|
864 | } |
---|
865 | \def\filenamecatcodes{% |
---|
866 | \catcode`\\=\other |
---|
867 | \catcode`~=\other |
---|
868 | \catcode`^=\other |
---|
869 | \catcode`_=\other |
---|
870 | \catcode`|=\other |
---|
871 | \catcode`<=\other |
---|
872 | \catcode`>=\other |
---|
873 | \catcode`+=\other |
---|
874 | \catcode`-=\other |
---|
875 | } |
---|
876 | |
---|
877 | \def\pushthisfilestack{% |
---|
878 | \expandafter\pushthisfilestackX\popthisfilestack\StackTerm |
---|
879 | } |
---|
880 | \def\pushthisfilestackX{% |
---|
881 | \expandafter\pushthisfilestackY\thisfile\StackTerm |
---|
882 | } |
---|
883 | \def\pushthisfilestackY #1\StackTerm #2\StackTerm {% |
---|
884 | \gdef\popthisfilestack{\gdef\thisfile{#1}\gdef\popthisfilestack{#2}}% |
---|
885 | } |
---|
886 | |
---|
887 | \def\popthisfilestack{\errthisfilestackempty} |
---|
888 | \def\errthisfilestackempty{\errmessage{Internal error: |
---|
889 | the stack of filenames is empty.}} |
---|
890 | |
---|
891 | \def\thisfile{} |
---|
892 | |
---|
893 | % @center line |
---|
894 | % outputs that line, centered. |
---|
895 | % |
---|
896 | \parseargdef\center{% |
---|
897 | \ifhmode |
---|
898 | \let\next\centerH |
---|
899 | \else |
---|
900 | \let\next\centerV |
---|
901 | \fi |
---|
902 | \next{\hfil \ignorespaces#1\unskip \hfil}% |
---|
903 | } |
---|
904 | \def\centerH#1{% |
---|
905 | {% |
---|
906 | \hfil\break |
---|
907 | \advance\hsize by -\leftskip |
---|
908 | \advance\hsize by -\rightskip |
---|
909 | \line{#1}% |
---|
910 | \break |
---|
911 | }% |
---|
912 | } |
---|
913 | \def\centerV#1{\line{\kern\leftskip #1\kern\rightskip}} |
---|
914 | |
---|
915 | % @sp n outputs n lines of vertical space |
---|
916 | |
---|
917 | \parseargdef\sp{\vskip #1\baselineskip} |
---|
918 | |
---|
919 | % @comment ...line which is ignored... |
---|
920 | % @c is the same as @comment |
---|
921 | % @ignore ... @end ignore is another way to write a comment |
---|
922 | |
---|
923 | \def\comment{\begingroup \catcode`\^^M=\other% |
---|
924 | \catcode`\@=\other \catcode`\{=\other \catcode`\}=\other% |
---|
925 | \commentxxx} |
---|
926 | {\catcode`\^^M=\other \gdef\commentxxx#1^^M{\endgroup}} |
---|
927 | |
---|
928 | \let\c=\comment |
---|
929 | |
---|
930 | % @paragraphindent NCHARS |
---|
931 | % We'll use ems for NCHARS, close enough. |
---|
932 | % NCHARS can also be the word `asis' or `none'. |
---|
933 | % We cannot feasibly implement @paragraphindent asis, though. |
---|
934 | % |
---|
935 | \def\asisword{asis} % no translation, these are keywords |
---|
936 | \def\noneword{none} |
---|
937 | % |
---|
938 | \parseargdef\paragraphindent{% |
---|
939 | \def\temp{#1}% |
---|
940 | \ifx\temp\asisword |
---|
941 | \else |
---|
942 | \ifx\temp\noneword |
---|
943 | \defaultparindent = 0pt |
---|
944 | \else |
---|
945 | \defaultparindent = #1em |
---|
946 | \fi |
---|
947 | \fi |
---|
948 | \parindent = \defaultparindent |
---|
949 | } |
---|
950 | |
---|
951 | % @exampleindent NCHARS |
---|
952 | % We'll use ems for NCHARS like @paragraphindent. |
---|
953 | % It seems @exampleindent asis isn't necessary, but |
---|
954 | % I preserve it to make it similar to @paragraphindent. |
---|
955 | \parseargdef\exampleindent{% |
---|
956 | \def\temp{#1}% |
---|
957 | \ifx\temp\asisword |
---|
958 | \else |
---|
959 | \ifx\temp\noneword |
---|
960 | \lispnarrowing = 0pt |
---|
961 | \else |
---|
962 | \lispnarrowing = #1em |
---|
963 | \fi |
---|
964 | \fi |
---|
965 | } |
---|
966 | |
---|
967 | % @firstparagraphindent WORD |
---|
968 | % If WORD is `none', then suppress indentation of the first paragraph |
---|
969 | % after a section heading. If WORD is `insert', then do indent at such |
---|
970 | % paragraphs. |
---|
971 | % |
---|
972 | % The paragraph indentation is suppressed or not by calling |
---|
973 | % \suppressfirstparagraphindent, which the sectioning commands do. |
---|
974 | % We switch the definition of this back and forth according to WORD. |
---|
975 | % By default, we suppress indentation. |
---|
976 | % |
---|
977 | \def\suppressfirstparagraphindent{\dosuppressfirstparagraphindent} |
---|
978 | \def\insertword{insert} |
---|
979 | % |
---|
980 | \parseargdef\firstparagraphindent{% |
---|
981 | \def\temp{#1}% |
---|
982 | \ifx\temp\noneword |
---|
983 | \let\suppressfirstparagraphindent = \dosuppressfirstparagraphindent |
---|
984 | \else\ifx\temp\insertword |
---|
985 | \let\suppressfirstparagraphindent = \relax |
---|
986 | \else |
---|
987 | \errhelp = \EMsimple |
---|
988 | \errmessage{Unknown @firstparagraphindent option `\temp'}% |
---|
989 | \fi\fi |
---|
990 | } |
---|
991 | |
---|
992 | % Here is how we actually suppress indentation. Redefine \everypar to |
---|
993 | % \kern backwards by \parindent, and then reset itself to empty. |
---|
994 | % |
---|
995 | % We also make \indent itself not actually do anything until the next |
---|
996 | % paragraph. |
---|
997 | % |
---|
998 | \gdef\dosuppressfirstparagraphindent{% |
---|
999 | \gdef\indent{% |
---|
1000 | \restorefirstparagraphindent |
---|
1001 | \indent |
---|
1002 | }% |
---|
1003 | \gdef\noindent{% |
---|
1004 | \restorefirstparagraphindent |
---|
1005 | \noindent |
---|
1006 | }% |
---|
1007 | \global\everypar = {% |
---|
1008 | \kern -\parindent |
---|
1009 | \restorefirstparagraphindent |
---|
1010 | }% |
---|
1011 | } |
---|
1012 | |
---|
1013 | \gdef\restorefirstparagraphindent{% |
---|
1014 | \global \let \indent = \ptexindent |
---|
1015 | \global \let \noindent = \ptexnoindent |
---|
1016 | \global \everypar = {}% |
---|
1017 | } |
---|
1018 | |
---|
1019 | |
---|
1020 | % @asis just yields its argument. Used with @table, for example. |
---|
1021 | % |
---|
1022 | \def\asis#1{#1} |
---|
1023 | |
---|
1024 | % @math outputs its argument in math mode. |
---|
1025 | % |
---|
1026 | % One complication: _ usually means subscripts, but it could also mean |
---|
1027 | % an actual _ character, as in @math{@var{some_variable} + 1}. So make |
---|
1028 | % _ active, and distinguish by seeing if the current family is \slfam, |
---|
1029 | % which is what @var uses. |
---|
1030 | { |
---|
1031 | \catcode\underChar = \active |
---|
1032 | \gdef\mathunderscore{% |
---|
1033 | \catcode\underChar=\active |
---|
1034 | \def_{\ifnum\fam=\slfam \_\else\sb\fi}% |
---|
1035 | } |
---|
1036 | } |
---|
1037 | % Another complication: we want \\ (and @\) to output a \ character. |
---|
1038 | % FYI, plain.tex uses \\ as a temporary control sequence (why?), but |
---|
1039 | % this is not advertised and we don't care. Texinfo does not |
---|
1040 | % otherwise define @\. |
---|
1041 | % |
---|
1042 | % The \mathchar is class=0=ordinary, family=7=ttfam, position=5C=\. |
---|
1043 | \def\mathbackslash{\ifnum\fam=\ttfam \mathchar"075C \else\backslash \fi} |
---|
1044 | % |
---|
1045 | \def\math{% |
---|
1046 | \tex |
---|
1047 | \mathunderscore |
---|
1048 | \let\\ = \mathbackslash |
---|
1049 | \mathactive |
---|
1050 | $\finishmath |
---|
1051 | } |
---|
1052 | \def\finishmath#1{#1$\endgroup} % Close the group opened by \tex. |
---|
1053 | |
---|
1054 | % Some active characters (such as <) are spaced differently in math. |
---|
1055 | % We have to reset their definitions in case the @math was an argument |
---|
1056 | % to a command which sets the catcodes (such as @item or @section). |
---|
1057 | % |
---|
1058 | { |
---|
1059 | \catcode`^ = \active |
---|
1060 | \catcode`< = \active |
---|
1061 | \catcode`> = \active |
---|
1062 | \catcode`+ = \active |
---|
1063 | \gdef\mathactive{% |
---|
1064 | \let^ = \ptexhat |
---|
1065 | \let< = \ptexless |
---|
1066 | \let> = \ptexgtr |
---|
1067 | \let+ = \ptexplus |
---|
1068 | } |
---|
1069 | } |
---|
1070 | |
---|
1071 | % @bullet and @minus need the same treatment as @math, just above. |
---|
1072 | \def\bullet{$\ptexbullet$} |
---|
1073 | \def\minus{$-$} |
---|
1074 | |
---|
1075 | % @dots{} outputs an ellipsis using the current font. |
---|
1076 | % We do .5em per period so that it has the same spacing in a typewriter |
---|
1077 | % font as three actual period characters. |
---|
1078 | % |
---|
1079 | \def\dots{% |
---|
1080 | \leavevmode |
---|
1081 | \hbox to 1.5em{% |
---|
1082 | \hskip 0pt plus 0.25fil |
---|
1083 | .\hfil.\hfil.% |
---|
1084 | \hskip 0pt plus 0.5fil |
---|
1085 | }% |
---|
1086 | } |
---|
1087 | |
---|
1088 | % @enddots{} is an end-of-sentence ellipsis. |
---|
1089 | % |
---|
1090 | \def\enddots{% |
---|
1091 | \dots |
---|
1092 | \spacefactor=3000 |
---|
1093 | } |
---|
1094 | |
---|
1095 | % @comma{} is so commas can be inserted into text without messing up |
---|
1096 | % Texinfo's parsing. |
---|
1097 | % |
---|
1098 | \let\comma = , |
---|
1099 | |
---|
1100 | % @refill is a no-op. |
---|
1101 | \let\refill=\relax |
---|
1102 | |
---|
1103 | % If working on a large document in chapters, it is convenient to |
---|
1104 | % be able to disable indexing, cross-referencing, and contents, for test runs. |
---|
1105 | % This is done with @novalidate (before @setfilename). |
---|
1106 | % |
---|
1107 | \newif\iflinks \linkstrue % by default we want the aux files. |
---|
1108 | \let\novalidate = \linksfalse |
---|
1109 | |
---|
1110 | % @setfilename is done at the beginning of every texinfo file. |
---|
1111 | % So open here the files we need to have open while reading the input. |
---|
1112 | % This makes it possible to make a .fmt file for texinfo. |
---|
1113 | \def\setfilename{% |
---|
1114 | \fixbackslash % Turn off hack to swallow `\input texinfo'. |
---|
1115 | \iflinks |
---|
1116 | \tryauxfile |
---|
1117 | % Open the new aux file. TeX will close it automatically at exit. |
---|
1118 | \immediate\openout\auxfile=\jobname.aux |
---|
1119 | \fi % \openindices needs to do some work in any case. |
---|
1120 | \openindices |
---|
1121 | \let\setfilename=\comment % Ignore extra @setfilename cmds. |
---|
1122 | % |
---|
1123 | % If texinfo.cnf is present on the system, read it. |
---|
1124 | % Useful for site-wide @afourpaper, etc. |
---|
1125 | \openin 1 texinfo.cnf |
---|
1126 | \ifeof 1 \else \input texinfo.cnf \fi |
---|
1127 | \closein 1 |
---|
1128 | % |
---|
1129 | \comment % Ignore the actual filename. |
---|
1130 | } |
---|
1131 | |
---|
1132 | % Called from \setfilename. |
---|
1133 | % |
---|
1134 | \def\openindices{% |
---|
1135 | \newindex{cp}% |
---|
1136 | \newcodeindex{fn}% |
---|
1137 | \newcodeindex{vr}% |
---|
1138 | \newcodeindex{tp}% |
---|
1139 | \newcodeindex{ky}% |
---|
1140 | \newcodeindex{pg}% |
---|
1141 | } |
---|
1142 | |
---|
1143 | % @bye. |
---|
1144 | \outer\def\bye{\pagealignmacro\tracingstats=1\ptexend} |
---|
1145 | |
---|
1146 | |
---|
1147 | \message{pdf,} |
---|
1148 | % adobe `portable' document format |
---|
1149 | \newcount\tempnum |
---|
1150 | \newcount\lnkcount |
---|
1151 | \newtoks\filename |
---|
1152 | \newcount\filenamelength |
---|
1153 | \newcount\pgn |
---|
1154 | \newtoks\toksA |
---|
1155 | \newtoks\toksB |
---|
1156 | \newtoks\toksC |
---|
1157 | \newtoks\toksD |
---|
1158 | \newbox\boxA |
---|
1159 | \newcount\countA |
---|
1160 | \newif\ifpdf |
---|
1161 | \newif\ifpdfmakepagedest |
---|
1162 | |
---|
1163 | \ifx\pdfoutput\undefined |
---|
1164 | \pdffalse |
---|
1165 | \let\pdfmkdest = \gobble |
---|
1166 | \let\pdfurl = \gobble |
---|
1167 | \let\endlink = \relax |
---|
1168 | \let\linkcolor = \relax |
---|
1169 | \let\pdfmakeoutlines = \relax |
---|
1170 | \else |
---|
1171 | \pdftrue |
---|
1172 | \pdfoutput = 1 |
---|
1173 | \input pdfcolor |
---|
1174 | \pdfcatalog{/PageMode /UseOutlines}% |
---|
1175 | \def\dopdfimage#1#2#3{% |
---|
1176 | \def\imagewidth{#2}% |
---|
1177 | \def\imageheight{#3}% |
---|
1178 | % without \immediate, pdftex seg faults when the same image is |
---|
1179 | % included twice. (Version 3.14159-pre-1.0-unofficial-20010704.) |
---|
1180 | \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14 |
---|
1181 | \immediate\pdfimage |
---|
1182 | \else |
---|
1183 | \immediate\pdfximage |
---|
1184 | \fi |
---|
1185 | \ifx\empty\imagewidth\else width \imagewidth \fi |
---|
1186 | \ifx\empty\imageheight\else height \imageheight \fi |
---|
1187 | \ifnum\pdftexversion<13 |
---|
1188 | #1.pdf% |
---|
1189 | \else |
---|
1190 | {#1.pdf}% |
---|
1191 | \fi |
---|
1192 | \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14 \else |
---|
1193 | \pdfrefximage \pdflastximage |
---|
1194 | \fi} |
---|
1195 | \def\pdfmkdest#1{{% |
---|
1196 | % We have to set dummies so commands such as @code in a section title |
---|
1197 | % aren't expanded. |
---|
1198 | \atdummies |
---|
1199 | \normalturnoffactive |
---|
1200 | \pdfdest name{#1} xyz% |
---|
1201 | }} |
---|
1202 | \def\pdfmkpgn#1{#1} |
---|
1203 | \let\linkcolor = \Blue % was Cyan, but that seems light? |
---|
1204 | \def\endlink{\Black\pdfendlink} |
---|
1205 | % Adding outlines to PDF; macros for calculating structure of outlines |
---|
1206 | % come from Petr Olsak |
---|
1207 | \def\expnumber#1{\expandafter\ifx\csname#1\endcsname\relax 0% |
---|
1208 | \else \csname#1\endcsname \fi} |
---|
1209 | \def\advancenumber#1{\tempnum=\expnumber{#1}\relax |
---|
1210 | \advance\tempnum by 1 |
---|
1211 | \expandafter\xdef\csname#1\endcsname{\the\tempnum}} |
---|
1212 | % |
---|
1213 | % #1 is the section text. #2 is the pdf expression for the number |
---|
1214 | % of subentries (or empty, for subsubsections). #3 is the node |
---|
1215 | % text, which might be empty if this toc entry had no |
---|
1216 | % corresponding node. #4 is the page number. |
---|
1217 | % |
---|
1218 | \def\dopdfoutline#1#2#3#4{% |
---|
1219 | % Generate a link to the node text if that exists; else, use the |
---|
1220 | % page number. We could generate a destination for the section |
---|
1221 | % text in the case where a section has no node, but it doesn't |
---|
1222 | % seem worthwhile, since most documents are normally structured. |
---|
1223 | \def\pdfoutlinedest{#3}% |
---|
1224 | \ifx\pdfoutlinedest\empty \def\pdfoutlinedest{#4}\fi |
---|
1225 | % |
---|
1226 | \pdfoutline goto name{\pdfmkpgn{\pdfoutlinedest}}#2{#1}% |
---|
1227 | } |
---|
1228 | % |
---|
1229 | \def\pdfmakeoutlines{% |
---|
1230 | \begingroup |
---|
1231 | % Thanh's hack / proper braces in bookmarks |
---|
1232 | \edef\mylbrace{\iftrue \string{\else}\fi}\let\{=\mylbrace |
---|
1233 | \edef\myrbrace{\iffalse{\else\string}\fi}\let\}=\myrbrace |
---|
1234 | % |
---|
1235 | % Read toc silently, to get counts of subentries for \pdfoutline. |
---|
1236 | \def\numchapentry##1##2##3##4{% |
---|
1237 | \def\thischapnum{##2}% |
---|
1238 | \let\thissecnum\empty |
---|
1239 | \let\thissubsecnum\empty |
---|
1240 | }% |
---|
1241 | \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{% |
---|
1242 | \advancenumber{chap\thischapnum}% |
---|
1243 | \def\thissecnum{##2}% |
---|
1244 | \let\thissubsecnum\empty |
---|
1245 | }% |
---|
1246 | \def\numsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{% |
---|
1247 | \advancenumber{sec\thissecnum}% |
---|
1248 | \def\thissubsecnum{##2}% |
---|
1249 | }% |
---|
1250 | \def\numsubsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{% |
---|
1251 | \advancenumber{subsec\thissubsecnum}% |
---|
1252 | }% |
---|
1253 | \let\thischapnum\empty |
---|
1254 | \let\thissecnum\empty |
---|
1255 | \let\thissubsecnum\empty |
---|
1256 | % |
---|
1257 | % use \def rather than \let here because we redefine \chapentry et |
---|
1258 | % al. a second time, below. |
---|
1259 | \def\appentry{\numchapentry}% |
---|
1260 | \def\appsecentry{\numsecentry}% |
---|
1261 | \def\appsubsecentry{\numsubsecentry}% |
---|
1262 | \def\appsubsubsecentry{\numsubsubsecentry}% |
---|
1263 | \def\unnchapentry{\numchapentry}% |
---|
1264 | \def\unnsecentry{\numsecentry}% |
---|
1265 | \def\unnsubsecentry{\numsubsecentry}% |
---|
1266 | \def\unnsubsubsecentry{\numsubsubsecentry}% |
---|
1267 | \input \jobname.toc |
---|
1268 | % |
---|
1269 | % Read toc second time, this time actually producing the outlines. |
---|
1270 | % The `-' means take the \expnumber as the absolute number of |
---|
1271 | % subentries, which we calculated on our first read of the .toc above. |
---|
1272 | % |
---|
1273 | % We use the node names as the destinations. |
---|
1274 | \def\numchapentry##1##2##3##4{% |
---|
1275 | \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{chap##2}}{##3}{##4}}% |
---|
1276 | \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{% |
---|
1277 | \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{sec##2}}{##3}{##4}}% |
---|
1278 | \def\numsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{% |
---|
1279 | \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{subsec##2}}{##3}{##4}}% |
---|
1280 | \def\numsubsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{% count is always zero |
---|
1281 | \dopdfoutline{##1}{}{##3}{##4}}% |
---|
1282 | % |
---|
1283 | % PDF outlines are displayed using system fonts, instead of |
---|
1284 | % document fonts. Therefore we cannot use special characters, |
---|
1285 | % since the encoding is unknown. For example, the eogonek from |
---|
1286 | % Latin 2 (0xea) gets translated to a | character. Info from |
---|
1287 | % Staszek Wawrykiewicz, 19 Jan 2004 04:09:24 +0100. |
---|
1288 | % |
---|
1289 | % xx to do this right, we have to translate 8-bit characters to |
---|
1290 | % their "best" equivalent, based on the @documentencoding. Right |
---|
1291 | % now, I guess we'll just let the pdf reader have its way. |
---|
1292 | \indexnofonts |
---|
1293 | \turnoffactive |
---|
1294 | \input \jobname.toc |
---|
1295 | \endgroup |
---|
1296 | } |
---|
1297 | % |
---|
1298 | \def\makelinks #1,{% |
---|
1299 | \def\params{#1}\def\E{END}% |
---|
1300 | \ifx\params\E |
---|
1301 | \let\nextmakelinks=\relax |
---|
1302 | \else |
---|
1303 | \let\nextmakelinks=\makelinks |
---|
1304 | \ifnum\lnkcount>0,\fi |
---|
1305 | \picknum{#1}% |
---|
1306 | \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]} |
---|
1307 | goto name{\pdfmkpgn{\the\pgn}}% |
---|
1308 | \linkcolor #1% |
---|
1309 | \advance\lnkcount by 1% |
---|
1310 | \endlink |
---|
1311 | \fi |
---|
1312 | \nextmakelinks |
---|
1313 | } |
---|
1314 | \def\picknum#1{\expandafter\pn#1} |
---|
1315 | \def\pn#1{% |
---|
1316 | \def\p{#1}% |
---|
1317 | \ifx\p\lbrace |
---|
1318 | \let\nextpn=\ppn |
---|
1319 | \else |
---|
1320 | \let\nextpn=\ppnn |
---|
1321 | \def\first{#1} |
---|
1322 | \fi |
---|
1323 | \nextpn |
---|
1324 | } |
---|
1325 | \def\ppn#1{\pgn=#1\gobble} |
---|
1326 | \def\ppnn{\pgn=\first} |
---|
1327 | \def\pdfmklnk#1{\lnkcount=0\makelinks #1,END,} |
---|
1328 | \def\skipspaces#1{\def\PP{#1}\def\D{|}% |
---|
1329 | \ifx\PP\D\let\nextsp\relax |
---|
1330 | \else\let\nextsp\skipspaces |
---|
1331 | \ifx\p\space\else\addtokens{\filename}{\PP}% |
---|
1332 | \advance\filenamelength by 1 |
---|
1333 | \fi |
---|
1334 | \fi |
---|
1335 | \nextsp} |
---|
1336 | \def\getfilename#1{\filenamelength=0\expandafter\skipspaces#1|\relax} |
---|
1337 | \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14 |
---|
1338 | \let \startlink \pdfannotlink |
---|
1339 | \else |
---|
1340 | \let \startlink \pdfstartlink |
---|
1341 | \fi |
---|
1342 | \def\pdfurl#1{% |
---|
1343 | \begingroup |
---|
1344 | \normalturnoffactive\def\@{@}% |
---|
1345 | \makevalueexpandable |
---|
1346 | \leavevmode\Red |
---|
1347 | \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}% |
---|
1348 | user{/Subtype /Link /A << /S /URI /URI (#1) >>}% |
---|
1349 | \endgroup} |
---|
1350 | \def\pdfgettoks#1.{\setbox\boxA=\hbox{\toksA={#1.}\toksB={}\maketoks}} |
---|
1351 | \def\addtokens#1#2{\edef\addtoks{\noexpand#1={\the#1#2}}\addtoks} |
---|
1352 | \def\adn#1{\addtokens{\toksC}{#1}\global\countA=1\let\next=\maketoks} |
---|
1353 | \def\poptoks#1#2|ENDTOKS|{\let\first=#1\toksD={#1}\toksA={#2}} |
---|
1354 | \def\maketoks{% |
---|
1355 | \expandafter\poptoks\the\toksA|ENDTOKS|\relax |
---|
1356 | \ifx\first0\adn0 |
---|
1357 | \else\ifx\first1\adn1 \else\ifx\first2\adn2 \else\ifx\first3\adn3 |
---|
1358 | \else\ifx\first4\adn4 \else\ifx\first5\adn5 \else\ifx\first6\adn6 |
---|
1359 | \else\ifx\first7\adn7 \else\ifx\first8\adn8 \else\ifx\first9\adn9 |
---|
1360 | \else |
---|
1361 | \ifnum0=\countA\else\makelink\fi |
---|
1362 | \ifx\first.\let\next=\done\else |
---|
1363 | \let\next=\maketoks |
---|
1364 | \addtokens{\toksB}{\the\toksD} |
---|
1365 | \ifx\first,\addtokens{\toksB}{\space}\fi |
---|
1366 | \fi |
---|
1367 | \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi |
---|
1368 | \next} |
---|
1369 | \def\makelink{\addtokens{\toksB}% |
---|
1370 | {\noexpand\pdflink{\the\toksC}}\toksC={}\global\countA=0} |
---|
1371 | \def\pdflink#1{% |
---|
1372 | \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]} goto name{\pdfmkpgn{#1}} |
---|
1373 | \linkcolor #1\endlink} |
---|
1374 | \def\done{\edef\st{\global\noexpand\toksA={\the\toksB}}\st} |
---|
1375 | \fi % \ifx\pdfoutput |
---|
1376 | |
---|
1377 | |
---|
1378 | \message{fonts,} |
---|
1379 | |
---|
1380 | % Change the current font style to #1, remembering it in \curfontstyle. |
---|
1381 | % For now, we do not accumulate font styles: @b{@i{foo}} prints foo in |
---|
1382 | % italics, not bold italics. |
---|
1383 | % |
---|
1384 | \def\setfontstyle#1{% |
---|
1385 | \def\curfontstyle{#1}% not as a control sequence, because we are \edef'd. |
---|
1386 | \csname ten#1\endcsname % change the current font |
---|
1387 | } |
---|
1388 | |
---|
1389 | % Select #1 fonts with the current style. |
---|
1390 | % |
---|
1391 | \def\selectfonts#1{\csname #1fonts\endcsname \csname\curfontstyle\endcsname} |
---|
1392 | |
---|
1393 | \def\rm{\fam=0 \setfontstyle{rm}} |
---|
1394 | \def\it{\fam=\itfam \setfontstyle{it}} |
---|
1395 | \def\sl{\fam=\slfam \setfontstyle{sl}} |
---|
1396 | \def\bf{\fam=\bffam \setfontstyle{bf}} |
---|
1397 | \def\tt{\fam=\ttfam \setfontstyle{tt}} |
---|
1398 | |
---|
1399 | % Texinfo sort of supports the sans serif font style, which plain TeX does not. |
---|
1400 | % So we set up a \sf. |
---|
1401 | \newfam\sffam |
---|
1402 | \def\sf{\fam=\sffam \setfontstyle{sf}} |
---|
1403 | \let\li = \sf % Sometimes we call it \li, not \sf. |
---|
1404 | |
---|
1405 | % We don't need math for this font style. |
---|
1406 | \def\ttsl{\setfontstyle{ttsl}} |
---|
1407 | |
---|
1408 | % Default leading. |
---|
1409 | \newdimen\textleading \textleading = 13.2pt |
---|
1410 | |
---|
1411 | % Set the baselineskip to #1, and the lineskip and strut size |
---|
1412 | % correspondingly. There is no deep meaning behind these magic numbers |
---|
1413 | % used as factors; they just match (closely enough) what Knuth defined. |
---|
1414 | % |
---|
1415 | \def\lineskipfactor{.08333} |
---|
1416 | \def\strutheightpercent{.70833} |
---|
1417 | \def\strutdepthpercent {.29167} |
---|
1418 | % |
---|
1419 | \def\setleading#1{% |
---|
1420 | \normalbaselineskip = #1\relax |
---|
1421 | \normallineskip = \lineskipfactor\normalbaselineskip |
---|
1422 | \normalbaselines |
---|
1423 | \setbox\strutbox =\hbox{% |
---|
1424 | \vrule width0pt height\strutheightpercent\baselineskip |
---|
1425 | depth \strutdepthpercent \baselineskip |
---|
1426 | }% |
---|
1427 | } |
---|
1428 | |
---|
1429 | % Set the font macro #1 to the font named #2, adding on the |
---|
1430 | % specified font prefix (normally `cm'). |
---|
1431 | % #3 is the font's design size, #4 is a scale factor |
---|
1432 | \def\setfont#1#2#3#4{\font#1=\fontprefix#2#3 scaled #4} |
---|
1433 | |
---|
1434 | % Use cm as the default font prefix. |
---|
1435 | % To specify the font prefix, you must define \fontprefix |
---|
1436 | % before you read in texinfo.tex. |
---|
1437 | \ifx\fontprefix\undefined |
---|
1438 | \def\fontprefix{cm} |
---|
1439 | \fi |
---|
1440 | % Support font families that don't use the same naming scheme as CM. |
---|
1441 | \def\rmshape{r} |
---|
1442 | \def\rmbshape{bx} %where the normal face is bold |
---|
1443 | \def\bfshape{b} |
---|
1444 | \def\bxshape{bx} |
---|
1445 | \def\ttshape{tt} |
---|
1446 | \def\ttbshape{tt} |
---|
1447 | \def\ttslshape{sltt} |
---|
1448 | \def\itshape{ti} |
---|
1449 | \def\itbshape{bxti} |
---|
1450 | \def\slshape{sl} |
---|
1451 | \def\slbshape{bxsl} |
---|
1452 | \def\sfshape{ss} |
---|
1453 | \def\sfbshape{ss} |
---|
1454 | \def\scshape{csc} |
---|
1455 | \def\scbshape{csc} |
---|
1456 | |
---|
1457 | % Text fonts (11.2pt, magstep1). |
---|
1458 | \newcount\mainmagstep |
---|
1459 | \ifx\bigger\relax |
---|
1460 | % not really supported. |
---|
1461 | \mainmagstep=\magstep1 |
---|
1462 | \setfont\textrm\rmshape{12}{1000} |
---|
1463 | \setfont\texttt\ttshape{12}{1000} |
---|
1464 | \else |
---|
1465 | \mainmagstep=\magstephalf |
---|
1466 | \setfont\textrm\rmshape{10}{\mainmagstep} |
---|
1467 | \setfont\texttt\ttshape{10}{\mainmagstep} |
---|
1468 | \fi |
---|
1469 | \setfont\textbf\bfshape{10}{\mainmagstep} |
---|
1470 | \setfont\textit\itshape{10}{\mainmagstep} |
---|
1471 | \setfont\textsl\slshape{10}{\mainmagstep} |
---|
1472 | \setfont\textsf\sfshape{10}{\mainmagstep} |
---|
1473 | \setfont\textsc\scshape{10}{\mainmagstep} |
---|
1474 | \setfont\textttsl\ttslshape{10}{\mainmagstep} |
---|
1475 | \font\texti=cmmi10 scaled \mainmagstep |
---|
1476 | \font\textsy=cmsy10 scaled \mainmagstep |
---|
1477 | |
---|
1478 | % A few fonts for @defun names and args. |
---|
1479 | \setfont\defbf\bfshape{10}{\magstep1} |
---|
1480 | \setfont\deftt\ttshape{10}{\magstep1} |
---|
1481 | \setfont\defttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep1} |
---|
1482 | \def\df{\let\tentt=\deftt \let\tenbf = \defbf \let\tenttsl=\defttsl \bf} |
---|
1483 | |
---|
1484 | % Fonts for indices, footnotes, small examples (9pt). |
---|
1485 | \setfont\smallrm\rmshape{9}{1000} |
---|
1486 | \setfont\smalltt\ttshape{9}{1000} |
---|
1487 | \setfont\smallbf\bfshape{10}{900} |
---|
1488 | \setfont\smallit\itshape{9}{1000} |
---|
1489 | \setfont\smallsl\slshape{9}{1000} |
---|
1490 | \setfont\smallsf\sfshape{9}{1000} |
---|
1491 | \setfont\smallsc\scshape{10}{900} |
---|
1492 | \setfont\smallttsl\ttslshape{10}{900} |
---|
1493 | \font\smalli=cmmi9 |
---|
1494 | \font\smallsy=cmsy9 |
---|
1495 | |
---|
1496 | % Fonts for small examples (8pt). |
---|
1497 | \setfont\smallerrm\rmshape{8}{1000} |
---|
1498 | \setfont\smallertt\ttshape{8}{1000} |
---|
1499 | \setfont\smallerbf\bfshape{10}{800} |
---|
1500 | \setfont\smallerit\itshape{8}{1000} |
---|
1501 | \setfont\smallersl\slshape{8}{1000} |
---|
1502 | \setfont\smallersf\sfshape{8}{1000} |
---|
1503 | \setfont\smallersc\scshape{10}{800} |
---|
1504 | \setfont\smallerttsl\ttslshape{10}{800} |
---|
1505 | \font\smalleri=cmmi8 |
---|
1506 | \font\smallersy=cmsy8 |
---|
1507 | |
---|
1508 | % Fonts for title page (20.4pt): |
---|
1509 | \setfont\titlerm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep3} |
---|
1510 | \setfont\titleit\itbshape{10}{\magstep4} |
---|
1511 | \setfont\titlesl\slbshape{10}{\magstep4} |
---|
1512 | \setfont\titlett\ttbshape{12}{\magstep3} |
---|
1513 | \setfont\titlettsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep4} |
---|
1514 | \setfont\titlesf\sfbshape{17}{\magstep1} |
---|
1515 | \let\titlebf=\titlerm |
---|
1516 | \setfont\titlesc\scbshape{10}{\magstep4} |
---|
1517 | \font\titlei=cmmi12 scaled \magstep3 |
---|
1518 | \font\titlesy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep4 |
---|
1519 | \def\authorrm{\secrm} |
---|
1520 | \def\authortt{\sectt} |
---|
1521 | |
---|
1522 | % Chapter (and unnumbered) fonts (17.28pt). |
---|
1523 | \setfont\chaprm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep2} |
---|
1524 | \setfont\chapit\itbshape{10}{\magstep3} |
---|
1525 | \setfont\chapsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep3} |
---|
1526 | \setfont\chaptt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep2} |
---|
1527 | \setfont\chapttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep3} |
---|
1528 | \setfont\chapsf\sfbshape{17}{1000} |
---|
1529 | \let\chapbf=\chaprm |
---|
1530 | \setfont\chapsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep3} |
---|
1531 | \font\chapi=cmmi12 scaled \magstep2 |
---|
1532 | \font\chapsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep3 |
---|
1533 | |
---|
1534 | % Section fonts (14.4pt). |
---|
1535 | \setfont\secrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep1} |
---|
1536 | \setfont\secit\itbshape{10}{\magstep2} |
---|
1537 | \setfont\secsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep2} |
---|
1538 | \setfont\sectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep1} |
---|
1539 | \setfont\secttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep2} |
---|
1540 | \setfont\secsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstep1} |
---|
1541 | \let\secbf\secrm |
---|
1542 | \setfont\secsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep2} |
---|
1543 | \font\seci=cmmi12 scaled \magstep1 |
---|
1544 | \font\secsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep2 |
---|
1545 | |
---|
1546 | % Subsection fonts (13.15pt). |
---|
1547 | \setfont\ssecrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstephalf} |
---|
1548 | \setfont\ssecit\itbshape{10}{1315} |
---|
1549 | \setfont\ssecsl\slbshape{10}{1315} |
---|
1550 | \setfont\ssectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstephalf} |
---|
1551 | \setfont\ssecttsl\ttslshape{10}{1315} |
---|
1552 | \setfont\ssecsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstephalf} |
---|
1553 | \let\ssecbf\ssecrm |
---|
1554 | \setfont\ssecsc\scbshape{10}{1315} |
---|
1555 | \font\sseci=cmmi12 scaled \magstephalf |
---|
1556 | \font\ssecsy=cmsy10 scaled 1315 |
---|
1557 | |
---|
1558 | % Reduced fonts for @acro in text (10pt). |
---|
1559 | \setfont\reducedrm\rmshape{10}{1000} |
---|
1560 | \setfont\reducedtt\ttshape{10}{1000} |
---|
1561 | \setfont\reducedbf\bfshape{10}{1000} |
---|
1562 | \setfont\reducedit\itshape{10}{1000} |
---|
1563 | \setfont\reducedsl\slshape{10}{1000} |
---|
1564 | \setfont\reducedsf\sfshape{10}{1000} |
---|
1565 | \setfont\reducedsc\scshape{10}{1000} |
---|
1566 | \setfont\reducedttsl\ttslshape{10}{1000} |
---|
1567 | \font\reducedi=cmmi10 |
---|
1568 | \font\reducedsy=cmsy10 |
---|
1569 | |
---|
1570 | % In order for the font changes to affect most math symbols and letters, |
---|
1571 | % we have to define the \textfont of the standard families. Since |
---|
1572 | % texinfo doesn't allow for producing subscripts and superscripts except |
---|
1573 | % in the main text, we don't bother to reset \scriptfont and |
---|
1574 | % \scriptscriptfont (which would also require loading a lot more fonts). |
---|
1575 | % |
---|
1576 | \def\resetmathfonts{% |
---|
1577 | \textfont0=\tenrm \textfont1=\teni \textfont2=\tensy |
---|
1578 | \textfont\itfam=\tenit \textfont\slfam=\tensl \textfont\bffam=\tenbf |
---|
1579 | \textfont\ttfam=\tentt \textfont\sffam=\tensf |
---|
1580 | } |
---|
1581 | |
---|
1582 | % The font-changing commands redefine the meanings of \tenSTYLE, instead |
---|
1583 | % of just \STYLE. We do this because \STYLE needs to also set the |
---|
1584 | % current \fam for math mode. Our \STYLE (e.g., \rm) commands hardwire |
---|
1585 | % \tenSTYLE to set the current font. |
---|
1586 | % |
---|
1587 | % Each font-changing command also sets the names \lsize (one size lower) |
---|
1588 | % and \lllsize (three sizes lower). These relative commands are used in |
---|
1589 | % the LaTeX logo and acronyms. |
---|
1590 | % |
---|
1591 | % This all needs generalizing, badly. |
---|
1592 | % |
---|
1593 | \def\textfonts{% |
---|
1594 | \let\tenrm=\textrm \let\tenit=\textit \let\tensl=\textsl |
---|
1595 | \let\tenbf=\textbf \let\tentt=\texttt \let\smallcaps=\textsc |
---|
1596 | \let\tensf=\textsf \let\teni=\texti \let\tensy=\textsy |
---|
1597 | \let\tenttsl=\textttsl |
---|
1598 | \def\lsize{reduced}\def\lllsize{smaller}% |
---|
1599 | \resetmathfonts \setleading{\textleading}} |
---|
1600 | \def\titlefonts{% |
---|
1601 | \let\tenrm=\titlerm \let\tenit=\titleit \let\tensl=\titlesl |
---|
1602 | \let\tenbf=\titlebf \let\tentt=\titlett \let\smallcaps=\titlesc |
---|
1603 | \let\tensf=\titlesf \let\teni=\titlei \let\tensy=\titlesy |
---|
1604 | \let\tenttsl=\titlettsl |
---|
1605 | \def\lsize{chap}\def\lllsize{subsec}% |
---|
1606 | \resetmathfonts \setleading{25pt}} |
---|
1607 | \def\titlefont#1{{\titlefonts\rm #1}} |
---|
1608 | \def\chapfonts{% |
---|
1609 | \let\tenrm=\chaprm \let\tenit=\chapit \let\tensl=\chapsl |
---|
1610 | \let\tenbf=\chapbf \let\tentt=\chaptt \let\smallcaps=\chapsc |
---|
1611 | \let\tensf=\chapsf \let\teni=\chapi \let\tensy=\chapsy \let\tenttsl=\chapttsl |
---|
1612 | \def\lsize{sec}\def\lllsize{text}% |
---|
1613 | \resetmathfonts \setleading{19pt}} |
---|
1614 | \def\secfonts{% |
---|
1615 | \let\tenrm=\secrm \let\tenit=\secit \let\tensl=\secsl |
---|
1616 | \let\tenbf=\secbf \let\tentt=\sectt \let\smallcaps=\secsc |
---|
1617 | \let\tensf=\secsf \let\teni=\seci \let\tensy=\secsy |
---|
1618 | \let\tenttsl=\secttsl |
---|
1619 | \def\lsize{subsec}\def\lllsize{reduced}% |
---|
1620 | \resetmathfonts \setleading{16pt}} |
---|
1621 | \def\subsecfonts{% |
---|
1622 | \let\tenrm=\ssecrm \let\tenit=\ssecit \let\tensl=\ssecsl |
---|
1623 | \let\tenbf=\ssecbf \let\tentt=\ssectt \let\smallcaps=\ssecsc |
---|
1624 | \let\tensf=\ssecsf \let\teni=\sseci \let\tensy=\ssecsy |
---|
1625 | \let\tenttsl=\ssecttsl |
---|
1626 | \def\lsize{text}\def\lllsize{small}% |
---|
1627 | \resetmathfonts \setleading{15pt}} |
---|
1628 | \let\subsubsecfonts = \subsecfonts |
---|
1629 | \def\reducedfonts{% |
---|
1630 | \let\tenrm=\reducedrm \let\tenit=\reducedit \let\tensl=\reducedsl |
---|
1631 | \let\tenbf=\reducedbf \let\tentt=\reducedtt \let\reducedcaps=\reducedsc |
---|
1632 | \let\tensf=\reducedsf \let\teni=\reducedi \let\tensy=\reducedsy |
---|
1633 | \let\tenttsl=\reducedttsl |
---|
1634 | \def\lsize{small}\def\lllsize{smaller}% |
---|
1635 | \resetmathfonts \setleading{10.5pt}} |
---|
1636 | \def\smallfonts{% |
---|
1637 | \let\tenrm=\smallrm \let\tenit=\smallit \let\tensl=\smallsl |
---|
1638 | \let\tenbf=\smallbf \let\tentt=\smalltt \let\smallcaps=\smallsc |
---|
1639 | \let\tensf=\smallsf \let\teni=\smalli \let\tensy=\smallsy |
---|
1640 | \let\tenttsl=\smallttsl |
---|
1641 | \def\lsize{smaller}\def\lllsize{smaller}% |
---|
1642 | \resetmathfonts \setleading{10.5pt}} |
---|
1643 | \def\smallerfonts{% |
---|
1644 | \let\tenrm=\smallerrm \let\tenit=\smallerit \let\tensl=\smallersl |
---|
1645 | \let\tenbf=\smallerbf \let\tentt=\smallertt \let\smallcaps=\smallersc |
---|
1646 | \let\tensf=\smallersf \let\teni=\smalleri \let\tensy=\smallersy |
---|
1647 | \let\tenttsl=\smallerttsl |
---|
1648 | \def\lsize{smaller}\def\lllsize{smaller}% |
---|
1649 | \resetmathfonts \setleading{9.5pt}} |
---|
1650 | |
---|
1651 | % Set the fonts to use with the @small... environments. |
---|
1652 | \let\smallexamplefonts = \smallfonts |
---|
1653 | |
---|
1654 | % About \smallexamplefonts. If we use \smallfonts (9pt), @smallexample |
---|
1655 | % can fit this many characters: |
---|
1656 | % 8.5x11=86 smallbook=72 a4=90 a5=69 |
---|
1657 | % If we use \scriptfonts (8pt), then we can fit this many characters: |
---|
1658 | % 8.5x11=90+ smallbook=80 a4=90+ a5=77 |
---|
1659 | % For me, subjectively, the few extra characters that fit aren't worth |
---|
1660 | % the additional smallness of 8pt. So I'm making the default 9pt. |
---|
1661 | % |
---|
1662 | % By the way, for comparison, here's what fits with @example (10pt): |
---|
1663 | % 8.5x11=71 smallbook=60 a4=75 a5=58 |
---|
1664 | % |
---|
1665 | % I wish the USA used A4 paper. |
---|
1666 | % --karl, 24jan03. |
---|
1667 | |
---|
1668 | |
---|
1669 | % Set up the default fonts, so we can use them for creating boxes. |
---|
1670 | % |
---|
1671 | \textfonts \rm |
---|
1672 | |
---|
1673 | % Define these so they can be easily changed for other fonts. |
---|
1674 | \def\angleleft{$\langle$} |
---|
1675 | \def\angleright{$\rangle$} |
---|
1676 | |
---|
1677 | % Count depth in font-changes, for error checks |
---|
1678 | \newcount\fontdepth \fontdepth=0 |
---|
1679 | |
---|
1680 | % Fonts for short table of contents. |
---|
1681 | \setfont\shortcontrm\rmshape{12}{1000} |
---|
1682 | \setfont\shortcontbf\bfshape{10}{\magstep1} % no cmb12 |
---|
1683 | \setfont\shortcontsl\slshape{12}{1000} |
---|
1684 | \setfont\shortconttt\ttshape{12}{1000} |
---|
1685 | |
---|
1686 | %% Add scribe-like font environments, plus @l for inline lisp (usually sans |
---|
1687 | %% serif) and @ii for TeX italic |
---|
1688 | |
---|
1689 | % \smartitalic{ARG} outputs arg in italics, followed by an italic correction |
---|
1690 | % unless the following character is such as not to need one. |
---|
1691 | \def\smartitalicx{\ifx\next,\else\ifx\next-\else\ifx\next.\else |
---|
1692 | \ptexslash\fi\fi\fi} |
---|
1693 | \def\smartslanted#1{{\ifusingtt\ttsl\sl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx} |
---|
1694 | \def\smartitalic#1{{\ifusingtt\ttsl\it #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx} |
---|
1695 | |
---|
1696 | % like \smartslanted except unconditionally uses \ttsl. |
---|
1697 | % @var is set to this for defun arguments. |
---|
1698 | \def\ttslanted#1{{\ttsl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx} |
---|
1699 | |
---|
1700 | % like \smartslanted except unconditionally use \sl. We never want |
---|
1701 | % ttsl for book titles, do we? |
---|
1702 | \def\cite#1{{\sl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx} |
---|
1703 | |
---|
1704 | \let\i=\smartitalic |
---|
1705 | \let\var=\smartslanted |
---|
1706 | \let\dfn=\smartslanted |
---|
1707 | \let\emph=\smartitalic |
---|
1708 | |
---|
1709 | \def\b#1{{\bf #1}} |
---|
1710 | \let\strong=\b |
---|
1711 | |
---|
1712 | % We can't just use \exhyphenpenalty, because that only has effect at |
---|
1713 | % the end of a paragraph. Restore normal hyphenation at the end of the |
---|
1714 | % group within which \nohyphenation is presumably called. |
---|
1715 | % |
---|
1716 | \def\nohyphenation{\hyphenchar\font = -1 \aftergroup\restorehyphenation} |
---|
1717 | \def\restorehyphenation{\hyphenchar\font = `- } |
---|
1718 | |
---|
1719 | % Set sfcode to normal for the chars that usually have another value. |
---|
1720 | % Can't use plain's \frenchspacing because it uses the `\x notation, and |
---|
1721 | % sometimes \x has an active definition that messes things up. |
---|
1722 | % |
---|
1723 | \catcode`@=11 |
---|
1724 | \def\frenchspacing{% |
---|
1725 | \sfcode\dotChar =\@m \sfcode\questChar=\@m \sfcode\exclamChar=\@m |
---|
1726 | \sfcode\colonChar=\@m \sfcode\semiChar =\@m \sfcode\commaChar =\@m |
---|
1727 | } |
---|
1728 | \catcode`@=\other |
---|
1729 | |
---|
1730 | \def\t#1{% |
---|
1731 | {\tt \rawbackslash \frenchspacing #1}% |
---|
1732 | \null |
---|
1733 | } |
---|
1734 | \def\samp#1{`\tclose{#1}'\null} |
---|
1735 | \setfont\keyrm\rmshape{8}{1000} |
---|
1736 | \font\keysy=cmsy9 |
---|
1737 | \def\key#1{{\keyrm\textfont2=\keysy \leavevmode\hbox{% |
---|
1738 | \raise0.4pt\hbox{\angleleft}\kern-.08em\vtop{% |
---|
1739 | \vbox{\hrule\kern-0.4pt |
---|
1740 | \hbox{\raise0.4pt\hbox{\vphantom{\angleleft}}#1}}% |
---|
1741 | \kern-0.4pt\hrule}% |
---|
1742 | \kern-.06em\raise0.4pt\hbox{\angleright}}}} |
---|
1743 | % The old definition, with no lozenge: |
---|
1744 | %\def\key #1{{\ttsl \nohyphenation \uppercase{#1}}\null} |
---|
1745 | \def\ctrl #1{{\tt \rawbackslash \hat}#1} |
---|
1746 | |
---|
1747 | % @file, @option are the same as @samp. |
---|
1748 | \let\file=\samp |
---|
1749 | \let\option=\samp |
---|
1750 | |
---|
1751 | % @code is a modification of @t, |
---|
1752 | % which makes spaces the same size as normal in the surrounding text. |
---|
1753 | \def\tclose#1{% |
---|
1754 | {% |
---|
1755 | % Change normal interword space to be same as for the current font. |
---|
1756 | \spaceskip = \fontdimen2\font |
---|
1757 | % |
---|
1758 | % Switch to typewriter. |
---|
1759 | \tt |
---|
1760 | % |
---|
1761 | % But `\ ' produces the large typewriter interword space. |
---|
1762 | \def\ {{\spaceskip = 0pt{} }}% |
---|
1763 | % |
---|
1764 | % Turn off hyphenation. |
---|
1765 | \nohyphenation |
---|
1766 | % |
---|
1767 | \rawbackslash |
---|
1768 | \frenchspacing |
---|
1769 | #1% |
---|
1770 | }% |
---|
1771 | \null |
---|
1772 | } |
---|
1773 | |
---|
1774 | % We *must* turn on hyphenation at `-' and `_' in @code. |
---|
1775 | % Otherwise, it is too hard to avoid overfull hboxes |
---|
1776 | % in the Emacs manual, the Library manual, etc. |
---|
1777 | |
---|
1778 | % Unfortunately, TeX uses one parameter (\hyphenchar) to control |
---|
1779 | % both hyphenation at - and hyphenation within words. |
---|
1780 | % We must therefore turn them both off (\tclose does that) |
---|
1781 | % and arrange explicitly to hyphenate at a dash. |
---|
1782 | % -- rms. |
---|
1783 | { |
---|
1784 | \catcode`\-=\active |
---|
1785 | \catcode`\_=\active |
---|
1786 | % |
---|
1787 | \global\def\code{\begingroup |
---|
1788 | \catcode`\-=\active \let-\codedash |
---|
1789 | \catcode`\_=\active \let_\codeunder |
---|
1790 | \codex |
---|
1791 | } |
---|
1792 | } |
---|
1793 | |
---|
1794 | \def\realdash{-} |
---|
1795 | \def\codedash{-\discretionary{}{}{}} |
---|
1796 | \def\codeunder{% |
---|
1797 | % this is all so @math{@code{var_name}+1} can work. In math mode, _ |
---|
1798 | % is "active" (mathcode"8000) and \normalunderscore (or \char95, etc.) |
---|
1799 | % will therefore expand the active definition of _, which is us |
---|
1800 | % (inside @code that is), therefore an endless loop. |
---|
1801 | \ifusingtt{\ifmmode |
---|
1802 | \mathchar"075F % class 0=ordinary, family 7=ttfam, pos 0x5F=_. |
---|
1803 | \else\normalunderscore \fi |
---|
1804 | \discretionary{}{}{}}% |
---|
1805 | {\_}% |
---|
1806 | } |
---|
1807 | \def\codex #1{\tclose{#1}\endgroup} |
---|
1808 | |
---|
1809 | % @kbd is like @code, except that if the argument is just one @key command, |
---|
1810 | % then @kbd has no effect. |
---|
1811 | |
---|
1812 | % @kbdinputstyle -- arg is `distinct' (@kbd uses slanted tty font always), |
---|
1813 | % `example' (@kbd uses ttsl only inside of @example and friends), |
---|
1814 | % or `code' (@kbd uses normal tty font always). |
---|
1815 | \parseargdef\kbdinputstyle{% |
---|
1816 | \def\arg{#1}% |
---|
1817 | \ifx\arg\worddistinct |
---|
1818 | \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\ttsl}\gdef\kbdfont{\ttsl}% |
---|
1819 | \else\ifx\arg\wordexample |
---|
1820 | \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\ttsl}\gdef\kbdfont{\tt}% |
---|
1821 | \else\ifx\arg\wordcode |
---|
1822 | \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\tt}\gdef\kbdfont{\tt}% |
---|
1823 | \else |
---|
1824 | \errhelp = \EMsimple |
---|
1825 | \errmessage{Unknown @kbdinputstyle option `\arg'}% |
---|
1826 | \fi\fi\fi |
---|
1827 | } |
---|
1828 | \def\worddistinct{distinct} |
---|
1829 | \def\wordexample{example} |
---|
1830 | \def\wordcode{code} |
---|
1831 | |
---|
1832 | % Default is `distinct.' |
---|
1833 | \kbdinputstyle distinct |
---|
1834 | |
---|
1835 | \def\xkey{\key} |
---|
1836 | \def\kbdfoo#1#2#3\par{\def\one{#1}\def\three{#3}\def\threex{??}% |
---|
1837 | \ifx\one\xkey\ifx\threex\three \key{#2}% |
---|
1838 | \else{\tclose{\kbdfont\look}}\fi |
---|
1839 | \else{\tclose{\kbdfont\look}}\fi} |
---|
1840 | |
---|
1841 | % For @url, @env, @command quotes seem unnecessary, so use \code. |
---|
1842 | \let\url=\code |
---|
1843 | \let\env=\code |
---|
1844 | \let\command=\code |
---|
1845 | |
---|
1846 | % @uref (abbreviation for `urlref') takes an optional (comma-separated) |
---|
1847 | % second argument specifying the text to display and an optional third |
---|
1848 | % arg as text to display instead of (rather than in addition to) the url |
---|
1849 | % itself. First (mandatory) arg is the url. Perhaps eventually put in |
---|
1850 | % a hypertex \special here. |
---|
1851 | % |
---|
1852 | \def\uref#1{\douref #1,,,\finish} |
---|
1853 | \def\douref#1,#2,#3,#4\finish{\begingroup |
---|
1854 | \unsepspaces |
---|
1855 | \pdfurl{#1}% |
---|
1856 | \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}% |
---|
1857 | \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt |
---|
1858 | \unhbox0 % third arg given, show only that |
---|
1859 | \else |
---|
1860 | \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}% |
---|
1861 | \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt |
---|
1862 | \ifpdf |
---|
1863 | \unhbox0 % PDF: 2nd arg given, show only it |
---|
1864 | \else |
---|
1865 | \unhbox0\ (\code{#1})% DVI: 2nd arg given, show both it and url |
---|
1866 | \fi |
---|
1867 | \else |
---|
1868 | \code{#1}% only url given, so show it |
---|
1869 | \fi |
---|
1870 | \fi |
---|
1871 | \endlink |
---|
1872 | \endgroup} |
---|
1873 | |
---|
1874 | % rms does not like angle brackets --karl, 17may97. |
---|
1875 | % So now @email is just like @uref, unless we are pdf. |
---|
1876 | % |
---|
1877 | %\def\email#1{\angleleft{\tt #1}\angleright} |
---|
1878 | \ifpdf |
---|
1879 | \def\email#1{\doemail#1,,\finish} |
---|
1880 | \def\doemail#1,#2,#3\finish{\begingroup |
---|
1881 | \unsepspaces |
---|
1882 | \pdfurl{mailto:#1}% |
---|
1883 | \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}% |
---|
1884 | \ifdim\wd0>0pt\unhbox0\else\code{#1}\fi |
---|
1885 | \endlink |
---|
1886 | \endgroup} |
---|
1887 | \else |
---|
1888 | \let\email=\uref |
---|
1889 | \fi |
---|
1890 | |
---|
1891 | % Check if we are currently using a typewriter font. Since all the |
---|
1892 | % Computer Modern typewriter fonts have zero interword stretch (and |
---|
1893 | % shrink), and it is reasonable to expect all typewriter fonts to have |
---|
1894 | % this property, we can check that font parameter. |
---|
1895 | % |
---|
1896 | \def\ifmonospace{\ifdim\fontdimen3\font=0pt } |
---|
1897 | |
---|
1898 | % Typeset a dimension, e.g., `in' or `pt'. The only reason for the |
---|
1899 | % argument is to make the input look right: @dmn{pt} instead of @dmn{}pt. |
---|
1900 | % |
---|
1901 | \def\dmn#1{\thinspace #1} |
---|
1902 | |
---|
1903 | \def\kbd#1{\def\look{#1}\expandafter\kbdfoo\look??\par} |
---|
1904 | |
---|
1905 | % @l was never documented to mean ``switch to the Lisp font'', |
---|
1906 | % and it is not used as such in any manual I can find. We need it for |
---|
1907 | % Polish suppressed-l. --karl, 22sep96. |
---|
1908 | %\def\l#1{{\li #1}\null} |
---|
1909 | |
---|
1910 | % Explicit font changes: @r, @sc, undocumented @ii. |
---|
1911 | \def\r#1{{\rm #1}} % roman font |
---|
1912 | \def\sc#1{{\smallcaps#1}} % smallcaps font |
---|
1913 | \def\ii#1{{\it #1}} % italic font |
---|
1914 | |
---|
1915 | \def\acronym#1{\doacronym #1,,\finish} |
---|
1916 | \def\doacronym#1,#2,#3\finish{% |
---|
1917 | {\selectfonts\lsize #1}% |
---|
1918 | \def\temp{#2}% |
---|
1919 | \ifx\temp\empty \else |
---|
1920 | \space ({\unsepspaces \ignorespaces \temp \unskip})% |
---|
1921 | \fi |
---|
1922 | } |
---|
1923 | |
---|
1924 | % @pounds{} is a sterling sign, which is in the CM italic font. |
---|
1925 | % |
---|
1926 | \def\pounds{{\it\$}} |
---|
1927 | |
---|
1928 | % @registeredsymbol - R in a circle. The font for the R should really |
---|
1929 | % be smaller yet, but lllsize is the best we can do for now. |
---|
1930 | % Adapted from the plain.tex definition of \copyright. |
---|
1931 | % |
---|
1932 | \def\registeredsymbol{% |
---|
1933 | $^{{\ooalign{\hfil\raise.07ex\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize R}% |
---|
1934 | \hfil\crcr\Orb}}% |
---|
1935 | }$% |
---|
1936 | } |
---|
1937 | |
---|
1938 | |
---|
1939 | \message{page headings,} |
---|
1940 | |
---|
1941 | \newskip\titlepagetopglue \titlepagetopglue = 1.5in |
---|
1942 | \newskip\titlepagebottomglue \titlepagebottomglue = 2pc |
---|
1943 | |
---|
1944 | % First the title page. Must do @settitle before @titlepage. |
---|
1945 | \newif\ifseenauthor |
---|
1946 | \newif\iffinishedtitlepage |
---|
1947 | |
---|
1948 | % Do an implicit @contents or @shortcontents after @end titlepage if the |
---|
1949 | % user says @setcontentsaftertitlepage or @setshortcontentsaftertitlepage. |
---|
1950 | % |
---|
1951 | \newif\ifsetcontentsaftertitlepage |
---|
1952 | \let\setcontentsaftertitlepage = \setcontentsaftertitlepagetrue |
---|
1953 | \newif\ifsetshortcontentsaftertitlepage |
---|
1954 | \let\setshortcontentsaftertitlepage = \setshortcontentsaftertitlepagetrue |
---|
1955 | |
---|
1956 | \parseargdef\shorttitlepage{\begingroup\hbox{}\vskip 1.5in \chaprm \centerline{#1}% |
---|
1957 | \endgroup\page\hbox{}\page} |
---|
1958 | |
---|
1959 | \envdef\titlepage{% |
---|
1960 | % Open one extra group, as we want to close it in the middle of \Etitlepage. |
---|
1961 | \begingroup |
---|
1962 | \parindent=0pt \textfonts |
---|
1963 | % Leave some space at the very top of the page. |
---|
1964 | \vglue\titlepagetopglue |
---|
1965 | % No rule at page bottom unless we print one at the top with @title. |
---|
1966 | \finishedtitlepagetrue |
---|
1967 | % |
---|
1968 | % Most title ``pages'' are actually two pages long, with space |
---|
1969 | % at the top of the second. We don't want the ragged left on the second. |
---|
1970 | \let\oldpage = \page |
---|
1971 | \def\page{% |
---|
1972 | \iffinishedtitlepage\else |
---|
1973 | \finishtitlepage |
---|
1974 | \fi |
---|
1975 | \let\page = \oldpage |
---|
1976 | \page |
---|
1977 | \null |
---|
1978 | }% |
---|
1979 | } |
---|
1980 | |
---|
1981 | \def\Etitlepage{% |
---|
1982 | \iffinishedtitlepage\else |
---|
1983 | \finishtitlepage |
---|
1984 | \fi |
---|
1985 | % It is important to do the page break before ending the group, |
---|
1986 | % because the headline and footline are only empty inside the group. |
---|
1987 | % If we use the new definition of \page, we always get a blank page |
---|
1988 | % after the title page, which we certainly don't want. |
---|
1989 | \oldpage |
---|
1990 | \endgroup |
---|
1991 | % |
---|
1992 | % Need this before the \...aftertitlepage checks so that if they are |
---|
1993 | % in effect the toc pages will come out with page numbers. |
---|
1994 | \HEADINGSon |
---|
1995 | % |
---|
1996 | % If they want short, they certainly want long too. |
---|
1997 | \ifsetshortcontentsaftertitlepage |
---|
1998 | \shortcontents |
---|
1999 | \contents |
---|
2000 | \global\let\shortcontents = \relax |
---|
2001 | \global\let\contents = \relax |
---|
2002 | \fi |
---|
2003 | % |
---|
2004 | \ifsetcontentsaftertitlepage |
---|
2005 | \contents |
---|
2006 | \global\let\contents = \relax |
---|
2007 | \global\let\shortcontents = \relax |
---|
2008 | \fi |
---|
2009 | } |
---|
2010 | |
---|
2011 | \def\finishtitlepage{% |
---|
2012 | \vskip4pt \hrule height 2pt width \hsize |
---|
2013 | \vskip\titlepagebottomglue |
---|
2014 | \finishedtitlepagetrue |
---|
2015 | } |
---|
2016 | |
---|
2017 | %%% Macros to be used within @titlepage: |
---|
2018 | |
---|
2019 | \let\subtitlerm=\tenrm |
---|
2020 | \def\subtitlefont{\subtitlerm \normalbaselineskip = 13pt \normalbaselines} |
---|
2021 | |
---|
2022 | \def\authorfont{\authorrm \normalbaselineskip = 16pt \normalbaselines |
---|
2023 | \let\tt=\authortt} |
---|
2024 | |
---|
2025 | \parseargdef\title{% |
---|
2026 | \checkenv\titlepage |
---|
2027 | \leftline{\titlefonts\rm #1} |
---|
2028 | % print a rule at the page bottom also. |
---|
2029 | \finishedtitlepagefalse |
---|
2030 | \vskip4pt \hrule height 4pt width \hsize \vskip4pt |
---|
2031 | } |
---|
2032 | |
---|
2033 | \parseargdef\subtitle{% |
---|
2034 | \checkenv\titlepage |
---|
2035 | {\subtitlefont \rightline{#1}}% |
---|
2036 | } |
---|
2037 | |
---|
2038 | % @author should come last, but may come many times. |
---|
2039 | % It can also be used inside @quotation. |
---|
2040 | % |
---|
2041 | \parseargdef\author{% |
---|
2042 | \def\temp{\quotation}% |
---|
2043 | \ifx\thisenv\temp |
---|
2044 | \def\quotationauthor{#1}% printed in \Equotation. |
---|
2045 | \else |
---|
2046 | \checkenv\titlepage |
---|
2047 | \ifseenauthor\else \vskip 0pt plus 1filll \seenauthortrue \fi |
---|
2048 | {\authorfont \leftline{#1}}% |
---|
2049 | \fi |
---|
2050 | } |
---|
2051 | |
---|
2052 | |
---|
2053 | %%% Set up page headings and footings. |
---|
2054 | |
---|
2055 | \let\thispage=\folio |
---|
2056 | |
---|
2057 | \newtoks\evenheadline % headline on even pages |
---|
2058 | \newtoks\oddheadline % headline on odd pages |
---|
2059 | \newtoks\evenfootline % footline on even pages |
---|
2060 | \newtoks\oddfootline % footline on odd pages |
---|
2061 | |
---|
2062 | % Now make TeX use those variables |
---|
2063 | \headline={{\textfonts\rm \ifodd\pageno \the\oddheadline |
---|
2064 | \else \the\evenheadline \fi}} |
---|
2065 | \footline={{\textfonts\rm \ifodd\pageno \the\oddfootline |
---|
2066 | \else \the\evenfootline \fi}\HEADINGShook} |
---|
2067 | \let\HEADINGShook=\relax |
---|
2068 | |
---|
2069 | % Commands to set those variables. |
---|
2070 | % For example, this is what @headings on does |
---|
2071 | % @evenheading @thistitle|@thispage|@thischapter |
---|
2072 | % @oddheading @thischapter|@thispage|@thistitle |
---|
2073 | % @evenfooting @thisfile|| |
---|
2074 | % @oddfooting ||@thisfile |
---|
2075 | |
---|
2076 | |
---|
2077 | \def\evenheading{\parsearg\evenheadingxxx} |
---|
2078 | \def\evenheadingxxx #1{\evenheadingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish} |
---|
2079 | \def\evenheadingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{% |
---|
2080 | \global\evenheadline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}} |
---|
2081 | |
---|
2082 | \def\oddheading{\parsearg\oddheadingxxx} |
---|
2083 | \def\oddheadingxxx #1{\oddheadingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish} |
---|
2084 | \def\oddheadingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{% |
---|
2085 | \global\oddheadline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}} |
---|
2086 | |
---|
2087 | \parseargdef\everyheading{\oddheadingxxx{#1}\evenheadingxxx{#1}}% |
---|
2088 | |
---|
2089 | \def\evenfooting{\parsearg\evenfootingxxx} |
---|
2090 | \def\evenfootingxxx #1{\evenfootingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish} |
---|
2091 | \def\evenfootingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{% |
---|
2092 | \global\evenfootline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}} |
---|
2093 | |
---|
2094 | \def\oddfooting{\parsearg\oddfootingxxx} |
---|
2095 | \def\oddfootingxxx #1{\oddfootingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish} |
---|
2096 | \def\oddfootingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{% |
---|
2097 | \global\oddfootline = {\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}% |
---|
2098 | % |
---|
2099 | % Leave some space for the footline. Hopefully ok to assume |
---|
2100 | % @evenfooting will not be used by itself. |
---|
2101 | \global\advance\pageheight by -\baselineskip |
---|
2102 | \global\advance\vsize by -\baselineskip |
---|
2103 | } |
---|
2104 | |
---|
2105 | \parseargdef\everyfooting{\oddfootingxxx{#1}\evenfootingxxx{#1}} |
---|
2106 | |
---|
2107 | |
---|
2108 | % @headings double turns headings on for double-sided printing. |
---|
2109 | % @headings single turns headings on for single-sided printing. |
---|
2110 | % @headings off turns them off. |
---|
2111 | % @headings on same as @headings double, retained for compatibility. |
---|
2112 | % @headings after turns on double-sided headings after this page. |
---|
2113 | % @headings doubleafter turns on double-sided headings after this page. |
---|
2114 | % @headings singleafter turns on single-sided headings after this page. |
---|
2115 | % By default, they are off at the start of a document, |
---|
2116 | % and turned `on' after @end titlepage. |
---|
2117 | |
---|
2118 | \def\headings #1 {\csname HEADINGS#1\endcsname} |
---|
2119 | |
---|
2120 | \def\HEADINGSoff{% |
---|
2121 | \global\evenheadline={\hfil} \global\evenfootline={\hfil} |
---|
2122 | \global\oddheadline={\hfil} \global\oddfootline={\hfil}} |
---|
2123 | \HEADINGSoff |
---|
2124 | % When we turn headings on, set the page number to 1. |
---|
2125 | % For double-sided printing, put current file name in lower left corner, |
---|
2126 | % chapter name on inside top of right hand pages, document |
---|
2127 | % title on inside top of left hand pages, and page numbers on outside top |
---|
2128 | % edge of all pages. |
---|
2129 | \def\HEADINGSdouble{% |
---|
2130 | \global\pageno=1 |
---|
2131 | \global\evenfootline={\hfil} |
---|
2132 | \global\oddfootline={\hfil} |
---|
2133 | \global\evenheadline={\line{\folio\hfil\thistitle}} |
---|
2134 | \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}} |
---|
2135 | \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage |
---|
2136 | } |
---|
2137 | \let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager |
---|
2138 | |
---|
2139 | % For single-sided printing, chapter title goes across top left of page, |
---|
2140 | % page number on top right. |
---|
2141 | \def\HEADINGSsingle{% |
---|
2142 | \global\pageno=1 |
---|
2143 | \global\evenfootline={\hfil} |
---|
2144 | \global\oddfootline={\hfil} |
---|
2145 | \global\evenheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}} |
---|
2146 | \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}} |
---|
2147 | \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager |
---|
2148 | } |
---|
2149 | \def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSdouble} |
---|
2150 | |
---|
2151 | \def\HEADINGSafter{\let\HEADINGShook=\HEADINGSdoublex} |
---|
2152 | \let\HEADINGSdoubleafter=\HEADINGSafter |
---|
2153 | \def\HEADINGSdoublex{% |
---|
2154 | \global\evenfootline={\hfil} |
---|
2155 | \global\oddfootline={\hfil} |
---|
2156 | \global\evenheadline={\line{\folio\hfil\thistitle}} |
---|
2157 | \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}} |
---|
2158 | \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage |
---|
2159 | } |
---|
2160 | |
---|
2161 | \def\HEADINGSsingleafter{\let\HEADINGShook=\HEADINGSsinglex} |
---|
2162 | \def\HEADINGSsinglex{% |
---|
2163 | \global\evenfootline={\hfil} |
---|
2164 | \global\oddfootline={\hfil} |
---|
2165 | \global\evenheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}} |
---|
2166 | \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}} |
---|
2167 | \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager |
---|
2168 | } |
---|
2169 | |
---|
2170 | % Subroutines used in generating headings |
---|
2171 | % This produces Day Month Year style of output. |
---|
2172 | % Only define if not already defined, in case a txi-??.tex file has set |
---|
2173 | % up a different format (e.g., txi-cs.tex does this). |
---|
2174 | \ifx\today\undefined |
---|
2175 | \def\today{% |
---|
2176 | \number\day\space |
---|
2177 | \ifcase\month |
---|
2178 | \or\putwordMJan\or\putwordMFeb\or\putwordMMar\or\putwordMApr |
---|
2179 | \or\putwordMMay\or\putwordMJun\or\putwordMJul\or\putwordMAug |
---|
2180 | \or\putwordMSep\or\putwordMOct\or\putwordMNov\or\putwordMDec |
---|
2181 | \fi |
---|
2182 | \space\number\year} |
---|
2183 | \fi |
---|
2184 | |
---|
2185 | % @settitle line... specifies the title of the document, for headings. |
---|
2186 | % It generates no output of its own. |
---|
2187 | \def\thistitle{\putwordNoTitle} |
---|
2188 | \def\settitle{\parsearg{\gdef\thistitle}} |
---|
2189 | |
---|
2190 | |
---|
2191 | \message{tables,} |
---|
2192 | % Tables -- @table, @ftable, @vtable, @item(x). |
---|
2193 | |
---|
2194 | % default indentation of table text |
---|
2195 | \newdimen\tableindent \tableindent=.8in |
---|
2196 | % default indentation of @itemize and @enumerate text |
---|
2197 | \newdimen\itemindent \itemindent=.3in |
---|
2198 | % margin between end of table item and start of table text. |
---|
2199 | \newdimen\itemmargin \itemmargin=.1in |
---|
2200 | |
---|
2201 | % used internally for \itemindent minus \itemmargin |
---|
2202 | \newdimen\itemmax |
---|
2203 | |
---|
2204 | % Note @table, @ftable, and @vtable define @item, @itemx, etc., with |
---|
2205 | % these defs. |
---|
2206 | % They also define \itemindex |
---|
2207 | % to index the item name in whatever manner is desired (perhaps none). |
---|
2208 | |
---|
2209 | \newif\ifitemxneedsnegativevskip |
---|
2210 | |
---|
2211 | \def\itemxpar{\par\ifitemxneedsnegativevskip\nobreak\vskip-\parskip\nobreak\fi} |
---|
2212 | |
---|
2213 | \def\internalBitem{\smallbreak \parsearg\itemzzz} |
---|
2214 | \def\internalBitemx{\itemxpar \parsearg\itemzzz} |
---|
2215 | |
---|
2216 | \def\itemzzz #1{\begingroup % |
---|
2217 | \advance\hsize by -\rightskip |
---|
2218 | \advance\hsize by -\tableindent |
---|
2219 | \setbox0=\hbox{\itemindicate{#1}}% |
---|
2220 | \itemindex{#1}% |
---|
2221 | \nobreak % This prevents a break before @itemx. |
---|
2222 | % |
---|
2223 | % If the item text does not fit in the space we have, put it on a line |
---|
2224 | % by itself, and do not allow a page break either before or after that |
---|
2225 | % line. We do not start a paragraph here because then if the next |
---|
2226 | % command is, e.g., @kindex, the whatsit would get put into the |
---|
2227 | % horizontal list on a line by itself, resulting in extra blank space. |
---|
2228 | \ifdim \wd0>\itemmax |
---|
2229 | % |
---|
2230 | % Make this a paragraph so we get the \parskip glue and wrapping, |
---|
2231 | % but leave it ragged-right. |
---|
2232 | \begingroup |
---|
2233 | \advance\leftskip by-\tableindent |
---|
2234 | \advance\hsize by\tableindent |
---|
2235 | \advance\rightskip by0pt plus1fil |
---|
2236 | \leavevmode\unhbox0\par |
---|
2237 | \endgroup |
---|
2238 | % |
---|
2239 | % We're going to be starting a paragraph, but we don't want the |
---|
2240 | % \parskip glue -- logically it's part of the @item we just started. |
---|
2241 | \nobreak \vskip-\parskip |
---|
2242 | % |
---|
2243 | % Stop a page break at the \parskip glue coming up. (Unfortunately |
---|
2244 | % we can't prevent a possible page break at the following |
---|
2245 | % \baselineskip glue.) However, if what follows is an environment |
---|
2246 | % such as @example, there will be no \parskip glue; then |
---|
2247 | % the negative vskip we just would cause the example and the item to |
---|
2248 | % crash together. So we use this bizarre value of 10001 as a signal |
---|
2249 | % to \aboveenvbreak to insert \parskip glue after all. |
---|
2250 | % (Possibly there are other commands that could be followed by |
---|
2251 | % @example which need the same treatment, but not section titles; or |
---|
2252 | % maybe section titles are the only special case and they should be |
---|
2253 | % penalty 10001...) |
---|
2254 | \penalty 10001 |
---|
2255 | \endgroup |
---|
2256 | \itemxneedsnegativevskipfalse |
---|
2257 | \else |
---|
2258 | % The item text fits into the space. Start a paragraph, so that the |
---|
2259 | % following text (if any) will end up on the same line. |
---|
2260 | \noindent |
---|
2261 | % Do this with kerns and \unhbox so that if there is a footnote in |
---|
2262 | % the item text, it can migrate to the main vertical list and |
---|
2263 | % eventually be printed. |
---|
2264 | \nobreak\kern-\tableindent |
---|
2265 | \dimen0 = \itemmax \advance\dimen0 by \itemmargin \advance\dimen0 by -\wd0 |
---|
2266 | \unhbox0 |
---|
2267 | \nobreak\kern\dimen0 |
---|
2268 | \endgroup |
---|
2269 | \itemxneedsnegativevskiptrue |
---|
2270 | \fi |
---|
2271 | } |
---|
2272 | |
---|
2273 | \def\item{\errmessage{@item while not in a list environment}} |
---|
2274 | \def\itemx{\errmessage{@itemx while not in a list environment}} |
---|
2275 | |
---|
2276 | % @table, @ftable, @vtable. |
---|
2277 | \envdef\table{% |
---|
2278 | \let\itemindex\gobble |
---|
2279 | \tablex |
---|
2280 | } |
---|
2281 | \envdef\ftable{% |
---|
2282 | \def\itemindex ##1{\doind {fn}{\code{##1}}}% |
---|
2283 | \tablex |
---|
2284 | } |
---|
2285 | \envdef\vtable{% |
---|
2286 | \def\itemindex ##1{\doind {vr}{\code{##1}}}% |
---|
2287 | \tablex |
---|
2288 | } |
---|
2289 | \def\tablex#1{% |
---|
2290 | \def\itemindicate{#1}% |
---|
2291 | \parsearg\tabley |
---|
2292 | } |
---|
2293 | \def\tabley#1{% |
---|
2294 | {% |
---|
2295 | \makevalueexpandable |
---|
2296 | \edef\temp{\noexpand\tablez #1\space\space\space}% |
---|
2297 | \expandafter |
---|
2298 | }\temp \endtablez |
---|
2299 | } |
---|
2300 | \def\tablez #1 #2 #3 #4\endtablez{% |
---|
2301 | \aboveenvbreak |
---|
2302 | \ifnum 0#1>0 \advance \leftskip by #1\mil \fi |
---|
2303 | \ifnum 0#2>0 \tableindent=#2\mil \fi |
---|
2304 | \ifnum 0#3>0 \advance \rightskip by #3\mil \fi |
---|
2305 | \itemmax=\tableindent |
---|
2306 | \advance \itemmax by -\itemmargin |
---|
2307 | \advance \leftskip by \tableindent |
---|
2308 | \exdentamount=\tableindent |
---|
2309 | \parindent = 0pt |
---|
2310 | \parskip = \smallskipamount |
---|
2311 | \ifdim \parskip=0pt \parskip=2pt \fi |
---|
2312 | \let\item = \internalBitem |
---|
2313 | \let\itemx = \internalBitemx |
---|
2314 | } |
---|
2315 | \def\Etable{\endgraf\afterenvbreak} |
---|
2316 | \let\Eftable\Etable |
---|
2317 | \let\Evtable\Etable |
---|
2318 | \let\Eitemize\Etable |
---|
2319 | \let\Eenumerate\Etable |
---|
2320 | |
---|
2321 | % This is the counter used by @enumerate, which is really @itemize |
---|
2322 | |
---|
2323 | \newcount \itemno |
---|
2324 | |
---|
2325 | \envdef\itemize{\parsearg\doitemize} |
---|
2326 | |
---|
2327 | \def\doitemize#1{% |
---|
2328 | \aboveenvbreak |
---|
2329 | \itemmax=\itemindent |
---|
2330 | \advance\itemmax by -\itemmargin |
---|
2331 | \advance\leftskip by \itemindent |
---|
2332 | \exdentamount=\itemindent |
---|
2333 | \parindent=0pt |
---|
2334 | \parskip=\smallskipamount |
---|
2335 | \ifdim\parskip=0pt \parskip=2pt \fi |
---|
2336 | \def\itemcontents{#1}% |
---|
2337 | % @itemize with no arg is equivalent to @itemize @bullet. |
---|
2338 | \ifx\itemcontents\empty\def\itemcontents{\bullet}\fi |
---|
2339 | \let\item=\itemizeitem |
---|
2340 | } |
---|
2341 | |
---|
2342 | % Definition of @item while inside @itemize and @enumerate. |
---|
2343 | % |
---|
2344 | \def\itemizeitem{% |
---|
2345 | \advance\itemno by 1 % for enumerations |
---|
2346 | {\let\par=\endgraf \smallbreak}% reasonable place to break |
---|
2347 | {% |
---|
2348 | % If the document has an @itemize directly after a section title, a |
---|
2349 | % \nobreak will be last on the list, and \sectionheading will have |
---|
2350 | % done a \vskip-\parskip. In that case, we don't want to zero |
---|
2351 | % parskip, or the item text will crash with the heading. On the |
---|
2352 | % other hand, when there is normal text preceding the item (as there |
---|
2353 | % usually is), we do want to zero parskip, or there would be too much |
---|
2354 | % space. In that case, we won't have a \nobreak before. At least |
---|
2355 | % that's the theory. |
---|
2356 | \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000 \parskip=0in \fi |
---|
2357 | \noindent |
---|
2358 | \hbox to 0pt{\hss \itemcontents \kern\itemmargin}% |
---|
2359 | \vadjust{\penalty 1200}}% not good to break after first line of item. |
---|
2360 | \flushcr |
---|
2361 | } |
---|
2362 | |
---|
2363 | % \splitoff TOKENS\endmark defines \first to be the first token in |
---|
2364 | % TOKENS, and \rest to be the remainder. |
---|
2365 | % |
---|
2366 | \def\splitoff#1#2\endmark{\def\first{#1}\def\rest{#2}}% |
---|
2367 | |
---|
2368 | % Allow an optional argument of an uppercase letter, lowercase letter, |
---|
2369 | % or number, to specify the first label in the enumerated list. No |
---|
2370 | % argument is the same as `1'. |
---|
2371 | % |
---|
2372 | \envparseargdef\enumerate{\enumeratey #1 \endenumeratey} |
---|
2373 | \def\enumeratey #1 #2\endenumeratey{% |
---|
2374 | % If we were given no argument, pretend we were given `1'. |
---|
2375 | \def\thearg{#1}% |
---|
2376 | \ifx\thearg\empty \def\thearg{1}\fi |
---|
2377 | % |
---|
2378 | % Detect if the argument is a single token. If so, it might be a |
---|
2379 | % letter. Otherwise, the only valid thing it can be is a number. |
---|
2380 | % (We will always have one token, because of the test we just made. |
---|
2381 | % This is a good thing, since \splitoff doesn't work given nothing at |
---|
2382 | % all -- the first parameter is undelimited.) |
---|
2383 | \expandafter\splitoff\thearg\endmark |
---|
2384 | \ifx\rest\empty |
---|
2385 | % Only one token in the argument. It could still be anything. |
---|
2386 | % A ``lowercase letter'' is one whose \lccode is nonzero. |
---|
2387 | % An ``uppercase letter'' is one whose \lccode is both nonzero, and |
---|
2388 | % not equal to itself. |
---|
2389 | % Otherwise, we assume it's a number. |
---|
2390 | % |
---|
2391 | % We need the \relax at the end of the \ifnum lines to stop TeX from |
---|
2392 | % continuing to look for a <number>. |
---|
2393 | % |
---|
2394 | \ifnum\lccode\expandafter`\thearg=0\relax |
---|
2395 | \numericenumerate % a number (we hope) |
---|
2396 | \else |
---|
2397 | % It's a letter. |
---|
2398 | \ifnum\lccode\expandafter`\thearg=\expandafter`\thearg\relax |
---|
2399 | \lowercaseenumerate % lowercase letter |
---|
2400 | \else |
---|
2401 | \uppercaseenumerate % uppercase letter |
---|
2402 | \fi |
---|
2403 | \fi |
---|
2404 | \else |
---|
2405 | % Multiple tokens in the argument. We hope it's a number. |
---|
2406 | \numericenumerate |
---|
2407 | \fi |
---|
2408 | } |
---|
2409 | |
---|
2410 | % An @enumerate whose labels are integers. The starting integer is |
---|
2411 | % given in \thearg. |
---|
2412 | % |
---|
2413 | \def\numericenumerate{% |
---|
2414 | \itemno = \thearg |
---|
2415 | \startenumeration{\the\itemno}% |
---|
2416 | } |
---|
2417 | |
---|
2418 | % The starting (lowercase) letter is in \thearg. |
---|
2419 | \def\lowercaseenumerate{% |
---|
2420 | \itemno = \expandafter`\thearg |
---|
2421 | \startenumeration{% |
---|
2422 | % Be sure we're not beyond the end of the alphabet. |
---|
2423 | \ifnum\itemno=0 |
---|
2424 | \errmessage{No more lowercase letters in @enumerate; get a bigger |
---|
2425 | alphabet}% |
---|
2426 | \fi |
---|
2427 | \char\lccode\itemno |
---|
2428 | }% |
---|
2429 | } |
---|
2430 | |
---|
2431 | % The starting (uppercase) letter is in \thearg. |
---|
2432 | \def\uppercaseenumerate{% |
---|
2433 | \itemno = \expandafter`\thearg |
---|
2434 | \startenumeration{% |
---|
2435 | % Be sure we're not beyond the end of the alphabet. |
---|
2436 | \ifnum\itemno=0 |
---|
2437 | \errmessage{No more uppercase letters in @enumerate; get a bigger |
---|
2438 | alphabet} |
---|
2439 | \fi |
---|
2440 | \char\uccode\itemno |
---|
2441 | }% |
---|
2442 | } |
---|
2443 | |
---|
2444 | % Call \doitemize, adding a period to the first argument and supplying the |
---|
2445 | % common last two arguments. Also subtract one from the initial value in |
---|
2446 | % \itemno, since @item increments \itemno. |
---|
2447 | % |
---|
2448 | \def\startenumeration#1{% |
---|
2449 | \advance\itemno by -1 |
---|
2450 | \doitemize{#1.}\flushcr |
---|
2451 | } |
---|
2452 | |
---|
2453 | % @alphaenumerate and @capsenumerate are abbreviations for giving an arg |
---|
2454 | % to @enumerate. |
---|
2455 | % |
---|
2456 | \def\alphaenumerate{\enumerate{a}} |
---|
2457 | \def\capsenumerate{\enumerate{A}} |
---|
2458 | \def\Ealphaenumerate{\Eenumerate} |
---|
2459 | \def\Ecapsenumerate{\Eenumerate} |
---|
2460 | |
---|
2461 | |
---|
2462 | % @multitable macros |
---|
2463 | % Amy Hendrickson, 8/18/94, 3/6/96 |
---|
2464 | % |
---|
2465 | % @multitable ... @end multitable will make as many columns as desired. |
---|
2466 | % Contents of each column will wrap at width given in preamble. Width |
---|
2467 | % can be specified either with sample text given in a template line, |
---|
2468 | % or in percent of \hsize, the current width of text on page. |
---|
2469 | |
---|
2470 | % Table can continue over pages but will only break between lines. |
---|
2471 | |
---|
2472 | % To make preamble: |
---|
2473 | % |
---|
2474 | % Either define widths of columns in terms of percent of \hsize: |
---|
2475 | % @multitable @columnfractions .25 .3 .45 |
---|
2476 | % @item ... |
---|
2477 | % |
---|
2478 | % Numbers following @columnfractions are the percent of the total |
---|
2479 | % current hsize to be used for each column. You may use as many |
---|
2480 | % columns as desired. |
---|
2481 | |
---|
2482 | |
---|
2483 | % Or use a template: |
---|
2484 | % @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} {Column 3 template} |
---|
2485 | % @item ... |
---|
2486 | % using the widest term desired in each column. |
---|
2487 | |
---|
2488 | % Each new table line starts with @item, each subsequent new column |
---|
2489 | % starts with @tab. Empty columns may be produced by supplying @tab's |
---|
2490 | % with nothing between them for as many times as empty columns are needed, |
---|
2491 | % ie, @tab@tab@tab will produce two empty columns. |
---|
2492 | |
---|
2493 | % @item, @tab do not need to be on their own lines, but it will not hurt |
---|
2494 | % if they are. |
---|
2495 | |
---|
2496 | % Sample multitable: |
---|
2497 | |
---|
2498 | % @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} {Column 3 template} |
---|
2499 | % @item first col stuff @tab second col stuff @tab third col |
---|
2500 | % @item |
---|
2501 | % first col stuff |
---|
2502 | % @tab |
---|
2503 | % second col stuff |
---|
2504 | % @tab |
---|
2505 | % third col |
---|
2506 | % @item first col stuff @tab second col stuff |
---|
2507 | % @tab Many paragraphs of text may be used in any column. |
---|
2508 | % |
---|
2509 | % They will wrap at the width determined by the template. |
---|
2510 | % @item@tab@tab This will be in third column. |
---|
2511 | % @end multitable |
---|
2512 | |
---|
2513 | % Default dimensions may be reset by user. |
---|
2514 | % @multitableparskip is vertical space between paragraphs in table. |
---|
2515 | % @multitableparindent is paragraph indent in table. |
---|
2516 | % @multitablecolmargin is horizontal space to be left between columns. |
---|
2517 | % @multitablelinespace is space to leave between table items, baseline |
---|
2518 | % to baseline. |
---|
2519 | % 0pt means it depends on current normal line spacing. |
---|
2520 | % |
---|
2521 | \newskip\multitableparskip |
---|
2522 | \newskip\multitableparindent |
---|
2523 | \newdimen\multitablecolspace |
---|
2524 | \newskip\multitablelinespace |
---|
2525 | \multitableparskip=0pt |
---|
2526 | \multitableparindent=6pt |
---|
2527 | \multitablecolspace=12pt |
---|
2528 | \multitablelinespace=0pt |
---|
2529 | |
---|
2530 | % Macros used to set up halign preamble: |
---|
2531 | % |
---|
2532 | \let\endsetuptable\relax |
---|
2533 | \def\xendsetuptable{\endsetuptable} |
---|
2534 | \let\columnfractions\relax |
---|
2535 | \def\xcolumnfractions{\columnfractions} |
---|
2536 | \newif\ifsetpercent |
---|
2537 | |
---|
2538 | % #1 is the @columnfraction, usually a decimal number like .5, but might |
---|
2539 | % be just 1. We just use it, whatever it is. |
---|
2540 | % |
---|
2541 | \def\pickupwholefraction#1 {% |
---|
2542 | \global\advance\colcount by 1 |
---|
2543 | \expandafter\xdef\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname{#1\hsize}% |
---|
2544 | \setuptable |
---|
2545 | } |
---|
2546 | |
---|
2547 | \newcount\colcount |
---|
2548 | \def\setuptable#1{% |
---|
2549 | \def\firstarg{#1}% |
---|
2550 | \ifx\firstarg\xendsetuptable |
---|
2551 | \let\go = \relax |
---|
2552 | \else |
---|
2553 | \ifx\firstarg\xcolumnfractions |
---|
2554 | \global\setpercenttrue |
---|
2555 | \else |
---|
2556 | \ifsetpercent |
---|
2557 | \let\go\pickupwholefraction |
---|
2558 | \else |
---|
2559 | \global\advance\colcount by 1 |
---|
2560 | \setbox0=\hbox{#1\unskip\space}% Add a normal word space as a |
---|
2561 | % separator; typically that is always in the input, anyway. |
---|
2562 | \expandafter\xdef\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname{\the\wd0}% |
---|
2563 | \fi |
---|
2564 | \fi |
---|
2565 | \ifx\go\pickupwholefraction |
---|
2566 | % Put the argument back for the \pickupwholefraction call, so |
---|
2567 | % we'll always have a period there to be parsed. |
---|
2568 | \def\go{\pickupwholefraction#1}% |
---|
2569 | \else |
---|
2570 | \let\go = \setuptable |
---|
2571 | \fi% |
---|
2572 | \fi |
---|
2573 | \go |
---|
2574 | } |
---|
2575 | |
---|
2576 | % multitable-only commands. |
---|
2577 | % |
---|
2578 | % @headitem starts a heading row, which we typeset in bold. |
---|
2579 | % Assignments have to be global since we are inside the implicit group |
---|
2580 | % of an alignment entry. Note that \everycr resets \everytab. |
---|
2581 | \def\headitem{\checkenv\multitable \crcr \global\everytab={\bf}\the\everytab}% |
---|
2582 | % |
---|
2583 | % A \tab used to include \hskip1sp. But then the space in a template |
---|
2584 | % line is not enough. That is bad. So let's go back to just `&' until |
---|
2585 | % we encounter the problem it was intended to solve again. |
---|
2586 | % --karl, nathan@acm.org, 20apr99. |
---|
2587 | \def\tab{\checkenv\multitable &\the\everytab}% |
---|
2588 | |
---|
2589 | % @multitable ... @end multitable definitions: |
---|
2590 | % |
---|
2591 | \newtoks\everytab % insert after every tab. |
---|
2592 | % |
---|
2593 | \envdef\multitable{% |
---|
2594 | \vskip\parskip |
---|
2595 | \startsavinginserts |
---|
2596 | % |
---|
2597 | % @item within a multitable starts a normal row. |
---|
2598 | \let\item\crcr |
---|
2599 | % |
---|
2600 | \tolerance=9500 |
---|
2601 | \hbadness=9500 |
---|
2602 | \setmultitablespacing |
---|
2603 | \parskip=\multitableparskip |
---|
2604 | \parindent=\multitableparindent |
---|
2605 | \overfullrule=0pt |
---|
2606 | \global\colcount=0 |
---|
2607 | % |
---|
2608 | \everycr = {% |
---|
2609 | \noalign{% |
---|
2610 | \global\everytab={}% |
---|
2611 | \global\colcount=0 % Reset the column counter. |
---|
2612 | % Check for saved footnotes, etc. |
---|
2613 | \checkinserts |
---|
2614 | % Keeps underfull box messages off when table breaks over pages. |
---|
2615 | %\filbreak |
---|
2616 | % Maybe so, but it also creates really weird page breaks when the |
---|
2617 | % table breaks over pages. Wouldn't \vfil be better? Wait until the |
---|
2618 | % problem manifests itself, so it can be fixed for real --karl. |
---|
2619 | }% |
---|
2620 | }% |
---|
2621 | % |
---|
2622 | \parsearg\domultitable |
---|
2623 | } |
---|
2624 | \def\domultitable#1{% |
---|
2625 | % To parse everything between @multitable and @item: |
---|
2626 | \setuptable#1 \endsetuptable |
---|
2627 | % |
---|
2628 | % This preamble sets up a generic column definition, which will |
---|
2629 | % be used as many times as user calls for columns. |
---|
2630 | % \vtop will set a single line and will also let text wrap and |
---|
2631 | % continue for many paragraphs if desired. |
---|
2632 | \halign\bgroup &% |
---|
2633 | \global\advance\colcount by 1 |
---|
2634 | \multistrut |
---|
2635 | \vtop{% |
---|
2636 | % Use the current \colcount to find the correct column width: |
---|
2637 | \hsize=\expandafter\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname |
---|
2638 | % |
---|
2639 | % In order to keep entries from bumping into each other |
---|
2640 | % we will add a \leftskip of \multitablecolspace to all columns after |
---|
2641 | % the first one. |
---|
2642 | % |
---|
2643 | % If a template has been used, we will add \multitablecolspace |
---|
2644 | % to the width of each template entry. |
---|
2645 | % |
---|
2646 | % If the user has set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize we will |
---|
2647 | % use that dimension as the width of the column, and the \leftskip |
---|
2648 | % will keep entries from bumping into each other. Table will start at |
---|
2649 | % left margin and final column will justify at right margin. |
---|
2650 | % |
---|
2651 | % Make sure we don't inherit \rightskip from the outer environment. |
---|
2652 | \rightskip=0pt |
---|
2653 | \ifnum\colcount=1 |
---|
2654 | % The first column will be indented with the surrounding text. |
---|
2655 | \advance\hsize by\leftskip |
---|
2656 | \else |
---|
2657 | \ifsetpercent \else |
---|
2658 | % If user has not set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize |
---|
2659 | % we will advance \hsize by \multitablecolspace. |
---|
2660 | \advance\hsize by \multitablecolspace |
---|
2661 | \fi |
---|
2662 | % In either case we will make \leftskip=\multitablecolspace: |
---|
2663 | \leftskip=\multitablecolspace |
---|
2664 | \fi |
---|
2665 | % Ignoring space at the beginning and end avoids an occasional spurious |
---|
2666 | % blank line, when TeX decides to break the line at the space before the |
---|
2667 | % box from the multistrut, so the strut ends up on a line by itself. |
---|
2668 | % For example: |
---|
2669 | % @multitable @columnfractions .11 .89 |
---|
2670 | % @item @code{#} |
---|
2671 | % @tab Legal holiday which is valid in major parts of the whole country. |
---|
2672 | % Is automatically provided with highlighting sequences respectively |
---|
2673 | % marking characters. |
---|
2674 | \noindent\ignorespaces##\unskip\multistrut |
---|
2675 | }\cr |
---|
2676 | } |
---|
2677 | \def\Emultitable{% |
---|
2678 | \crcr |
---|
2679 | \egroup % end the \halign |
---|
2680 | \global\setpercentfalse |
---|
2681 | } |
---|
2682 | |
---|
2683 | \def\setmultitablespacing{% test to see if user has set \multitablelinespace. |
---|
2684 | % If so, do nothing. If not, give it an appropriate dimension based on |
---|
2685 | % current baselineskip. |
---|
2686 | \ifdim\multitablelinespace=0pt |
---|
2687 | \setbox0=\vbox{X}\global\multitablelinespace=\the\baselineskip |
---|
2688 | \global\advance\multitablelinespace by-\ht0 |
---|
2689 | %% strut to put in table in case some entry doesn't have descenders, |
---|
2690 | %% to keep lines equally spaced |
---|
2691 | \let\multistrut = \strut |
---|
2692 | \else |
---|
2693 | %% FIXME: what is \box0 supposed to be? |
---|
2694 | \gdef\multistrut{\vrule height\multitablelinespace depth\dp0 |
---|
2695 | width0pt\relax} \fi |
---|
2696 | %% Test to see if parskip is larger than space between lines of |
---|
2697 | %% table. If not, do nothing. |
---|
2698 | %% If so, set to same dimension as multitablelinespace. |
---|
2699 | \ifdim\multitableparskip>\multitablelinespace |
---|
2700 | \global\multitableparskip=\multitablelinespace |
---|
2701 | \global\advance\multitableparskip-7pt %% to keep parskip somewhat smaller |
---|
2702 | %% than skip between lines in the table. |
---|
2703 | \fi% |
---|
2704 | \ifdim\multitableparskip=0pt |
---|
2705 | \global\multitableparskip=\multitablelinespace |
---|
2706 | \global\advance\multitableparskip-7pt %% to keep parskip somewhat smaller |
---|
2707 | %% than skip between lines in the table. |
---|
2708 | \fi} |
---|
2709 | |
---|
2710 | |
---|
2711 | \message{conditionals,} |
---|
2712 | |
---|
2713 | % @iftex, @ifnotdocbook, @ifnothtml, @ifnotinfo, @ifnotplaintext, |
---|
2714 | % @ifnotxml always succeed. They currently do nothing; we don't |
---|
2715 | % attempt to check whether the conditionals are properly nested. But we |
---|
2716 | % have to remember that they are conditionals, so that @end doesn't |
---|
2717 | % attempt to close an environment group. |
---|
2718 | % |
---|
2719 | \def\makecond#1{% |
---|
2720 | \expandafter\let\csname #1\endcsname = \relax |
---|
2721 | \expandafter\let\csname iscond.#1\endcsname = 1 |
---|
2722 | } |
---|
2723 | \makecond{iftex} |
---|
2724 | \makecond{ifnotdocbook} |
---|
2725 | \makecond{ifnothtml} |
---|
2726 | \makecond{ifnotinfo} |
---|
2727 | \makecond{ifnotplaintext} |
---|
2728 | \makecond{ifnotxml} |
---|
2729 | |
---|
2730 | % Ignore @ignore, @ifhtml, @ifinfo, and the like. |
---|
2731 | % |
---|
2732 | \def\direntry{\doignore{direntry}} |
---|
2733 | \def\documentdescription{\doignore{documentdescription}} |
---|
2734 | \def\docbook{\doignore{docbook}} |
---|
2735 | \def\html{\doignore{html}} |
---|
2736 | \def\ifdocbook{\doignore{ifdocbook}} |
---|
2737 | \def\ifhtml{\doignore{ifhtml}} |
---|
2738 | \def\ifinfo{\doignore{ifinfo}} |
---|
2739 | \def\ifnottex{\doignore{ifnottex}} |
---|
2740 | \def\ifplaintext{\doignore{ifplaintext}} |
---|
2741 | \def\ifxml{\doignore{ifxml}} |
---|
2742 | \def\ignore{\doignore{ignore}} |
---|
2743 | \def\menu{\doignore{menu}} |
---|
2744 | \def\xml{\doignore{xml}} |
---|
2745 | |
---|
2746 | % Ignore text until a line `@end #1', keeping track of nested conditionals. |
---|
2747 | % |
---|
2748 | % A count to remember the depth of nesting. |
---|
2749 | \newcount\doignorecount |
---|
2750 | |
---|
2751 | \def\doignore#1{\begingroup |
---|
2752 | % Scan in ``verbatim'' mode: |
---|
2753 | \catcode`\@ = \other |
---|
2754 | \catcode`\{ = \other |
---|
2755 | \catcode`\} = \other |
---|
2756 | % |
---|
2757 | % Make sure that spaces turn into tokens that match what \doignoretext wants. |
---|
2758 | \spaceisspace |
---|
2759 | % |
---|
2760 | % Count number of #1's that we've seen. |
---|
2761 | \doignorecount = 0 |
---|
2762 | % |
---|
2763 | % Swallow text until we reach the matching `@end #1'. |
---|
2764 | \dodoignore {#1}% |
---|
2765 | } |
---|
2766 | |
---|
2767 | { \catcode`_=11 % We want to use \_STOP_ which cannot appear in texinfo source. |
---|
2768 | \obeylines % |
---|
2769 | % |
---|
2770 | \gdef\dodoignore#1{% |
---|
2771 | % #1 contains the string `ifinfo'. |
---|
2772 | % |
---|
2773 | % Define a command to find the next `@end #1', which must be on a line |
---|
2774 | % by itself. |
---|
2775 | \long\def\doignoretext##1^^M@end #1{\doignoretextyyy##1^^M@#1\_STOP_}% |
---|
2776 | % And this command to find another #1 command, at the beginning of a |
---|
2777 | % line. (Otherwise, we would consider a line `@c @ifset', for |
---|
2778 | % example, to count as an @ifset for nesting.) |
---|
2779 | \long\def\doignoretextyyy##1^^M@#1##2\_STOP_{\doignoreyyy{##2}\_STOP_}% |
---|
2780 | % |
---|
2781 | % And now expand that command. |
---|
2782 | \obeylines % |
---|
2783 | \doignoretext ^^M% |
---|
2784 | }% |
---|
2785 | } |
---|
2786 | |
---|
2787 | \def\doignoreyyy#1{% |
---|
2788 | \def\temp{#1}% |
---|
2789 | \ifx\temp\empty % Nothing found. |
---|
2790 | \let\next\doignoretextzzz |
---|
2791 | \else % Found a nested condition, ... |
---|
2792 | \advance\doignorecount by 1 |
---|
2793 | \let\next\doignoretextyyy % ..., look for another. |
---|
2794 | % If we're here, #1 ends with ^^M\ifinfo (for example). |
---|
2795 | \fi |
---|
2796 | \next #1% the token \_STOP_ is present just after this macro. |
---|
2797 | } |
---|
2798 | |
---|
2799 | % We have to swallow the remaining "\_STOP_". |
---|
2800 | % |
---|
2801 | \def\doignoretextzzz#1{% |
---|
2802 | \ifnum\doignorecount = 0 % We have just found the outermost @end. |
---|
2803 | \let\next\enddoignore |
---|
2804 | \else % Still inside a nested condition. |
---|
2805 | \advance\doignorecount by -1 |
---|
2806 | \let\next\doignoretext % Look for the next @end. |
---|
2807 | \fi |
---|
2808 | \next |
---|
2809 | } |
---|
2810 | |
---|
2811 | % Finish off ignored text. |
---|
2812 | \def\enddoignore{\endgroup\ignorespaces} |
---|
2813 | |
---|
2814 | |
---|
2815 | % @set VAR sets the variable VAR to an empty value. |
---|
2816 | % @set VAR REST-OF-LINE sets VAR to the value REST-OF-LINE. |
---|
2817 | % |
---|
2818 | % Since we want to separate VAR from REST-OF-LINE (which might be |
---|
2819 | % empty), we can't just use \parsearg; we have to insert a space of our |
---|
2820 | % own to delimit the rest of the line, and then take it out again if we |
---|
2821 | % didn't need it. |
---|
2822 | % We rely on the fact that \parsearg sets \catcode`\ =10. |
---|
2823 | % |
---|
2824 | \parseargdef\set{\setyyy#1 \endsetyyy} |
---|
2825 | \def\setyyy#1 #2\endsetyyy{% |
---|
2826 | {% |
---|
2827 | \makevalueexpandable |
---|
2828 | \def\temp{#2}% |
---|
2829 | \edef\next{\gdef\makecsname{SET#1}}% |
---|
2830 | \ifx\temp\empty |
---|
2831 | \next{}% |
---|
2832 | \else |
---|
2833 | \setzzz#2\endsetzzz |
---|
2834 | \fi |
---|
2835 | }% |
---|
2836 | } |
---|
2837 | % Remove the trailing space \setxxx inserted. |
---|
2838 | \def\setzzz#1 \endsetzzz{\next{#1}} |
---|
2839 | |
---|
2840 | % @clear VAR clears (i.e., unsets) the variable VAR. |
---|
2841 | % |
---|
2842 | \parseargdef\clear{% |
---|
2843 | {% |
---|
2844 | \makevalueexpandable |
---|
2845 | \global\expandafter\let\csname SET#1\endcsname=\relax |
---|
2846 | }% |
---|
2847 | } |
---|
2848 | |
---|
2849 | % @value{foo} gets the text saved in variable foo. |
---|
2850 | \def\value{\begingroup\makevalueexpandable\valuexxx} |
---|
2851 | \def\valuexxx#1{\expandablevalue{#1}\endgroup} |
---|
2852 | { |
---|
2853 | \catcode`\- = \active \catcode`\_ = \active |
---|
2854 | % |
---|
2855 | \gdef\makevalueexpandable{% |
---|
2856 | \let\value = \expandablevalue |
---|
2857 | % We don't want these characters active, ... |
---|
2858 | \catcode`\-=\other \catcode`\_=\other |
---|
2859 | % ..., but we might end up with active ones in the argument if |
---|
2860 | % we're called from @code, as @code{@value{foo-bar_}}, though. |
---|
2861 | % So \let them to their normal equivalents. |
---|
2862 | \let-\realdash \let_\normalunderscore |
---|
2863 | } |
---|
2864 | } |
---|
2865 | |
---|
2866 | % We have this subroutine so that we can handle at least some @value's |
---|
2867 | % properly in indexes (we call \makevalueexpandable in \indexdummies). |
---|
2868 | % The command has to be fully expandable (if the variable is set), since |
---|
2869 | % the result winds up in the index file. This means that if the |
---|
2870 | % variable's value contains other Texinfo commands, it's almost certain |
---|
2871 | % it will fail (although perhaps we could fix that with sufficient work |
---|
2872 | % to do a one-level expansion on the result, instead of complete). |
---|
2873 | % |
---|
2874 | \def\expandablevalue#1{% |
---|
2875 | \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#1\endcsname\relax |
---|
2876 | {[No value for ``#1'']}% |
---|
2877 | \message{Variable `#1', used in @value, is not set.}% |
---|
2878 | \else |
---|
2879 | \csname SET#1\endcsname |
---|
2880 | \fi |
---|
2881 | } |
---|
2882 | |
---|
2883 | % @ifset VAR ... @end ifset reads the `...' iff VAR has been defined |
---|
2884 | % with @set. |
---|
2885 | % |
---|
2886 | % To get special treatment of `@end ifset,' call \makeond and the redefine. |
---|
2887 | % |
---|
2888 | \makecond{ifset} |
---|
2889 | \def\ifset{\parsearg{\doifset{\let\next=\ifsetfail}}} |
---|
2890 | \def\doifset#1#2{% |
---|
2891 | {% |
---|
2892 | \makevalueexpandable |
---|
2893 | \let\next=\empty |
---|
2894 | \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#2\endcsname\relax |
---|
2895 | #1% If not set, redefine \next. |
---|
2896 | \fi |
---|
2897 | \expandafter |
---|
2898 | }\next |
---|
2899 | } |
---|
2900 | \def\ifsetfail{\doignore{ifset}} |
---|
2901 | |
---|
2902 | % @ifclear VAR ... @end ifclear reads the `...' iff VAR has never been |
---|
2903 | % defined with @set, or has been undefined with @clear. |
---|
2904 | % |
---|
2905 | % The `\else' inside the `\doifset' parameter is a trick to reuse the |
---|
2906 | % above code: if the variable is not set, do nothing, if it is set, |
---|
2907 | % then redefine \next to \ifclearfail. |
---|
2908 | % |
---|
2909 | \makecond{ifclear} |
---|
2910 | \def\ifclear{\parsearg{\doifset{\else \let\next=\ifclearfail}}} |
---|
2911 | \def\ifclearfail{\doignore{ifclear}} |
---|
2912 | |
---|
2913 | % @dircategory CATEGORY -- specify a category of the dir file |
---|
2914 | % which this file should belong to. Ignore this in TeX. |
---|
2915 | \let\dircategory=\comment |
---|
2916 | |
---|
2917 | % @defininfoenclose. |
---|
2918 | \let\definfoenclose=\comment |
---|
2919 | |
---|
2920 | |
---|
2921 | \message{indexing,} |
---|
2922 | % Index generation facilities |
---|
2923 | |
---|
2924 | % Define \newwrite to be identical to plain tex's \newwrite |
---|
2925 | % except not \outer, so it can be used within \newindex. |
---|
2926 | {\catcode`\@=11 |
---|
2927 | \gdef\newwrite{\alloc@7\write\chardef\sixt@@n}} |
---|
2928 | |
---|
2929 | % \newindex {foo} defines an index named foo. |
---|
2930 | % It automatically defines \fooindex such that |
---|
2931 | % \fooindex ...rest of line... puts an entry in the index foo. |
---|
2932 | % It also defines \fooindfile to be the number of the output channel for |
---|
2933 | % the file that accumulates this index. The file's extension is foo. |
---|
2934 | % The name of an index should be no more than 2 characters long |
---|
2935 | % for the sake of vms. |
---|
2936 | % |
---|
2937 | \def\newindex#1{% |
---|
2938 | \iflinks |
---|
2939 | \expandafter\newwrite \csname#1indfile\endcsname |
---|
2940 | \openout \csname#1indfile\endcsname \jobname.#1 % Open the file |
---|
2941 | \fi |
---|
2942 | \expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{% % Define @#1index |
---|
2943 | \noexpand\doindex{#1}} |
---|
2944 | } |
---|
2945 | |
---|
2946 | % @defindex foo == \newindex{foo} |
---|
2947 | % |
---|
2948 | \def\defindex{\parsearg\newindex} |
---|
2949 | |
---|
2950 | % Define @defcodeindex, like @defindex except put all entries in @code. |
---|
2951 | % |
---|
2952 | \def\defcodeindex{\parsearg\newcodeindex} |
---|
2953 | % |
---|
2954 | \def\newcodeindex#1{% |
---|
2955 | \iflinks |
---|
2956 | \expandafter\newwrite \csname#1indfile\endcsname |
---|
2957 | \openout \csname#1indfile\endcsname \jobname.#1 |
---|
2958 | \fi |
---|
2959 | \expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{% |
---|
2960 | \noexpand\docodeindex{#1}}% |
---|
2961 | } |
---|
2962 | |
---|
2963 | |
---|
2964 | % @synindex foo bar makes index foo feed into index bar. |
---|
2965 | % Do this instead of @defindex foo if you don't want it as a separate index. |
---|
2966 | % |
---|
2967 | % @syncodeindex foo bar similar, but put all entries made for index foo |
---|
2968 | % inside @code. |
---|
2969 | % |
---|
2970 | \def\synindex#1 #2 {\dosynindex\doindex{#1}{#2}} |
---|
2971 | \def\syncodeindex#1 #2 {\dosynindex\docodeindex{#1}{#2}} |
---|
2972 | |
---|
2973 | % #1 is \doindex or \docodeindex, #2 the index getting redefined (foo), |
---|
2974 | % #3 the target index (bar). |
---|
2975 | \def\dosynindex#1#2#3{% |
---|
2976 | % Only do \closeout if we haven't already done it, else we'll end up |
---|
2977 | % closing the target index. |
---|
2978 | \expandafter \ifx\csname donesynindex#2\endcsname \undefined |
---|
2979 | % The \closeout helps reduce unnecessary open files; the limit on the |
---|
2980 | % Acorn RISC OS is a mere 16 files. |
---|
2981 | \expandafter\closeout\csname#2indfile\endcsname |
---|
2982 | \expandafter\let\csname\donesynindex#2\endcsname = 1 |
---|
2983 | \fi |
---|
2984 | % redefine \fooindfile: |
---|
2985 | \expandafter\let\expandafter\temp\expandafter=\csname#3indfile\endcsname |
---|
2986 | \expandafter\let\csname#2indfile\endcsname=\temp |
---|
2987 | % redefine \fooindex: |
---|
2988 | \expandafter\xdef\csname#2index\endcsname{\noexpand#1{#3}}% |
---|
2989 | } |
---|
2990 | |
---|
2991 | % Define \doindex, the driver for all \fooindex macros. |
---|
2992 | % Argument #1 is generated by the calling \fooindex macro, |
---|
2993 | % and it is "foo", the name of the index. |
---|
2994 | |
---|
2995 | % \doindex just uses \parsearg; it calls \doind for the actual work. |
---|
2996 | % This is because \doind is more useful to call from other macros. |
---|
2997 | |
---|
2998 | % There is also \dosubind {index}{topic}{subtopic} |
---|
2999 | % which makes an entry in a two-level index such as the operation index. |
---|
3000 | |
---|
3001 | \def\doindex#1{\edef\indexname{#1}\parsearg\singleindexer} |
---|
3002 | \def\singleindexer #1{\doind{\indexname}{#1}} |
---|
3003 | |
---|
3004 | % like the previous two, but they put @code around the argument. |
---|
3005 | \def\docodeindex#1{\edef\indexname{#1}\parsearg\singlecodeindexer} |
---|
3006 | \def\singlecodeindexer #1{\doind{\indexname}{\code{#1}}} |
---|
3007 | |
---|
3008 | % Take care of Texinfo commands that can appear in an index entry. |
---|
3009 | % Since there are some commands we want to expand, and others we don't, |
---|
3010 | % we have to laboriously prevent expansion for those that we don't. |
---|
3011 | % |
---|
3012 | \def\indexdummies{% |
---|
3013 | \def\@{@}% change to @@ when we switch to @ as escape char in index files. |
---|
3014 | \def\ {\realbackslash\space }% |
---|
3015 | % Need these in case \tex is in effect and \{ is a \delimiter again. |
---|
3016 | % But can't use \lbracecmd and \rbracecmd because texindex assumes |
---|
3017 | % braces and backslashes are used only as delimiters. |
---|
3018 | \let\{ = \mylbrace |
---|
3019 | \let\} = \myrbrace |
---|
3020 | % |
---|
3021 | % \definedummyword defines \#1 as \realbackslash #1\space, thus |
---|
3022 | % effectively preventing its expansion. This is used only for control |
---|
3023 | % words, not control letters, because the \space would be incorrect |
---|
3024 | % for control characters, but is needed to separate the control word |
---|
3025 | % from whatever follows. |
---|
3026 | % |
---|
3027 | % For control letters, we have \definedummyletter, which omits the |
---|
3028 | % space. |
---|
3029 | % |
---|
3030 | % These can be used both for control words that take an argument and |
---|
3031 | % those that do not. If it is followed by {arg} in the input, then |
---|
3032 | % that will dutifully get written to the index (or wherever). |
---|
3033 | % |
---|
3034 | \def\definedummyword##1{% |
---|
3035 | \expandafter\def\csname ##1\endcsname{\realbackslash ##1\space}% |
---|
3036 | }% |
---|
3037 | \def\definedummyletter##1{% |
---|
3038 | \expandafter\def\csname ##1\endcsname{\realbackslash ##1}% |
---|
3039 | }% |
---|
3040 | % |
---|
3041 | % Do the redefinitions. |
---|
3042 | \commondummies |
---|
3043 | } |
---|
3044 | |
---|
3045 | % For the aux file, @ is the escape character. So we want to redefine |
---|
3046 | % everything using @ instead of \realbackslash. When everything uses |
---|
3047 | % @, this will be simpler. |
---|
3048 | % |
---|
3049 | \def\atdummies{% |
---|
3050 | \def\@{@@}% |
---|
3051 | \def\ {@ }% |
---|
3052 | \let\{ = \lbraceatcmd |
---|
3053 | \let\} = \rbraceatcmd |
---|
3054 | % |
---|
3055 | % (See comments in \indexdummies.) |
---|
3056 | \def\definedummyword##1{% |
---|
3057 | \expandafter\def\csname ##1\endcsname{@##1\space}% |
---|
3058 | }% |
---|
3059 | \def\definedummyletter##1{% |
---|
3060 | \expandafter\def\csname ##1\endcsname{@##1}% |
---|
3061 | }% |
---|
3062 | % |
---|
3063 | % Do the redefinitions. |
---|
3064 | \commondummies |
---|
3065 | } |
---|
3066 | |
---|
3067 | % Called from \indexdummies and \atdummies. \definedummyword and |
---|
3068 | % \definedummyletter must be defined first. |
---|
3069 | % |
---|
3070 | \def\commondummies{% |
---|
3071 | % |
---|
3072 | \normalturnoffactive |
---|
3073 | % |
---|
3074 | \commondummiesnofonts |
---|
3075 | % |
---|
3076 | \definedummyletter{_}% |
---|
3077 | % |
---|
3078 | % Non-English letters. |
---|
3079 | \definedummyword{AA}% |
---|
3080 | \definedummyword{AE}% |
---|
3081 | \definedummyword{L}% |
---|
3082 | \definedummyword{OE}% |
---|
3083 | \definedummyword{O}% |
---|
3084 | \definedummyword{aa}% |
---|
3085 | \definedummyword{ae}% |
---|
3086 | \definedummyword{l}% |
---|
3087 | \definedummyword{oe}% |
---|
3088 | \definedummyword{o}% |
---|
3089 | \definedummyword{ss}% |
---|
3090 | \definedummyword{exclamdown}% |
---|
3091 | \definedummyword{questiondown}% |
---|
3092 | \definedummyword{ordf}% |
---|
3093 | \definedummyword{ordm}% |
---|
3094 | % |
---|
3095 | % Although these internal commands shouldn't show up, sometimes they do. |
---|
3096 | \definedummyword{bf}% |
---|
3097 | \definedummyword{gtr}% |
---|
3098 | \definedummyword{hat}% |
---|
3099 | \definedummyword{less}% |
---|
3100 | \definedummyword{sf}% |
---|
3101 | \definedummyword{sl}% |
---|
3102 | \definedummyword{tclose}% |
---|
3103 | \definedummyword{tt}% |
---|
3104 | % |
---|
3105 | \definedummyword{LaTeX}% |
---|
3106 | \definedummyword{TeX}% |
---|
3107 | % |
---|
3108 | % Assorted special characters. |
---|
3109 | \definedummyword{bullet}% |
---|
3110 | \definedummyword{copyright}% |
---|
3111 | \definedummyword{registeredsymbol}% |
---|
3112 | \definedummyword{dots}% |
---|
3113 | \definedummyword{enddots}% |
---|
3114 | \definedummyword{equiv}% |
---|
3115 | \definedummyword{error}% |
---|
3116 | \definedummyword{expansion}% |
---|
3117 | \definedummyword{minus}% |
---|
3118 | \definedummyword{pounds}% |
---|
3119 | \definedummyword{point}% |
---|
3120 | \definedummyword{print}% |
---|
3121 | \definedummyword{result}% |
---|
3122 | % |
---|
3123 | % Handle some cases of @value -- where it does not contain any |
---|
3124 | % (non-fully-expandable) commands. |
---|
3125 | \makevalueexpandable |
---|
3126 | % |
---|
3127 | % Normal spaces, not active ones. |
---|
3128 | \unsepspaces |
---|
3129 | % |
---|
3130 | % No macro expansion. |
---|
3131 | \turnoffmacros |
---|
3132 | } |
---|
3133 | |
---|
3134 | % \commondummiesnofonts: common to \commondummies and \indexnofonts. |
---|
3135 | % |
---|
3136 | % Better have this without active chars. |
---|
3137 | { |
---|
3138 | \catcode`\~=\other |
---|
3139 | \gdef\commondummiesnofonts{% |
---|
3140 | % Control letters and accents. |
---|
3141 | \definedummyletter{!}% |
---|
3142 | \definedummyletter{"}% |
---|
3143 | \definedummyletter{'}% |
---|
3144 | \definedummyletter{*}% |
---|
3145 | \definedummyletter{,}% |
---|
3146 | \definedummyletter{.}% |
---|
3147 | \definedummyletter{/}% |
---|
3148 | \definedummyletter{:}% |
---|
3149 | \definedummyletter{=}% |
---|
3150 | \definedummyletter{?}% |
---|
3151 | \definedummyletter{^}% |
---|
3152 | \definedummyletter{`}% |
---|
3153 | \definedummyletter{~}% |
---|
3154 | \definedummyword{u}% |
---|
3155 | \definedummyword{v}% |
---|
3156 | \definedummyword{H}% |
---|
3157 | \definedummyword{dotaccent}% |
---|
3158 | \definedummyword{ringaccent}% |
---|
3159 | \definedummyword{tieaccent}% |
---|
3160 | \definedummyword{ubaraccent}% |
---|
3161 | \definedummyword{udotaccent}% |
---|
3162 | \definedummyword{dotless}% |
---|
3163 | % |
---|
3164 | % Texinfo font commands. |
---|
3165 | \definedummyword{b}% |
---|
3166 | \definedummyword{i}% |
---|
3167 | \definedummyword{r}% |
---|
3168 | \definedummyword{sc}% |
---|
3169 | \definedummyword{t}% |
---|
3170 | % |
---|
3171 | % Commands that take arguments. |
---|
3172 | \definedummyword{acronym}% |
---|
3173 | \definedummyword{cite}% |
---|
3174 | \definedummyword{code}% |
---|
3175 | \definedummyword{command}% |
---|
3176 | \definedummyword{dfn}% |
---|
3177 | \definedummyword{emph}% |
---|
3178 | \definedummyword{env}% |
---|
3179 | \definedummyword{file}% |
---|
3180 | \definedummyword{kbd}% |
---|
3181 | \definedummyword{key}% |
---|
3182 | \definedummyword{math}% |
---|
3183 | \definedummyword{option}% |
---|
3184 | \definedummyword{samp}% |
---|
3185 | \definedummyword{strong}% |
---|
3186 | \definedummyword{tie}% |
---|
3187 | \definedummyword{uref}% |
---|
3188 | \definedummyword{url}% |
---|
3189 | \definedummyword{var}% |
---|
3190 | \definedummyword{verb}% |
---|
3191 | \definedummyword{w}% |
---|
3192 | } |
---|
3193 | } |
---|
3194 | |
---|
3195 | % \indexnofonts is used when outputting the strings to sort the index |
---|
3196 | % by, and when constructing control sequence names. It eliminates all |
---|
3197 | % control sequences and just writes whatever the best ASCII sort string |
---|
3198 | % would be for a given command (usually its argument). |
---|
3199 | % |
---|
3200 | \def\indexnofonts{% |
---|
3201 | \def\definedummyword##1{% |
---|
3202 | \expandafter\let\csname ##1\endcsname\asis |
---|
3203 | }% |
---|
3204 | \let\definedummyletter=\definedummyword |
---|
3205 | % |
---|
3206 | \commondummiesnofonts |
---|
3207 | % |
---|
3208 | % Don't no-op \tt, since it isn't a user-level command |
---|
3209 | % and is used in the definitions of the active chars like <, >, |, etc. |
---|
3210 | % Likewise with the other plain tex font commands. |
---|
3211 | %\let\tt=\asis |
---|
3212 | % |
---|
3213 | \def\ { }% |
---|
3214 | \def\@{@}% |
---|
3215 | % how to handle braces? |
---|
3216 | \def\_{\normalunderscore}% |
---|
3217 | % |
---|
3218 | % Non-English letters. |
---|
3219 | \def\AA{AA}% |
---|
3220 | \def\AE{AE}% |
---|
3221 | \def\L{L}% |
---|
3222 | \def\OE{OE}% |
---|
3223 | \def\O{O}% |
---|
3224 | \def\aa{aa}% |
---|
3225 | \def\ae{ae}% |
---|
3226 | \def\l{l}% |
---|
3227 | \def\oe{oe}% |
---|
3228 | \def\o{o}% |
---|
3229 | \def\ss{ss}% |
---|
3230 | \def\exclamdown{!}% |
---|
3231 | \def\questiondown{?}% |
---|
3232 | \def\ordf{a}% |
---|
3233 | \def\ordm{o}% |
---|
3234 | % |
---|
3235 | \def\LaTeX{LaTeX}% |
---|
3236 | \def\TeX{TeX}% |
---|
3237 | % |
---|
3238 | % Assorted special characters. |
---|
3239 | % (The following {} will end up in the sort string, but that's ok.) |
---|
3240 | \def\bullet{bullet}% |
---|
3241 | \def\copyright{copyright}% |
---|
3242 | \def\registeredsymbol{R}% |
---|
3243 | \def\dots{...}% |
---|
3244 | \def\enddots{...}% |
---|
3245 | \def\equiv{==}% |
---|
3246 | \def\error{error}% |
---|
3247 | \def\expansion{==>}% |
---|
3248 | \def\minus{-}% |
---|
3249 | \def\pounds{pounds}% |
---|
3250 | \def\point{.}% |
---|
3251 | \def\print{-|}% |
---|
3252 | \def\result{=>}% |
---|
3253 | } |
---|
3254 | |
---|
3255 | \let\indexbackslash=0 %overridden during \printindex. |
---|
3256 | \let\SETmarginindex=\relax % put index entries in margin (undocumented)? |
---|
3257 | |
---|
3258 | % Most index entries go through here, but \dosubind is the general case. |
---|
3259 | % #1 is the index name, #2 is the entry text. |
---|
3260 | \def\doind#1#2{\dosubind{#1}{#2}{}} |
---|
3261 | |
---|
3262 | % Workhorse for all \fooindexes. |
---|
3263 | % #1 is name of index, #2 is stuff to put there, #3 is subentry -- |
---|
3264 | % empty if called from \doind, as we usually are (the main exception |
---|
3265 | % is with most defuns, which call us directly). |
---|
3266 | % |
---|
3267 | \def\dosubind#1#2#3{% |
---|
3268 | \iflinks |
---|
3269 | {% |
---|
3270 | % Store the main index entry text (including the third arg). |
---|
3271 | \toks0 = {#2}% |
---|
3272 | % If third arg is present, precede it with a space. |
---|
3273 | \def\thirdarg{#3}% |
---|
3274 | \ifx\thirdarg\empty \else |
---|
3275 | \toks0 = \expandafter{\the\toks0 \space #3}% |
---|
3276 | \fi |
---|
3277 | % |
---|
3278 | \edef\writeto{\csname#1indfile\endcsname}% |
---|
3279 | % |
---|
3280 | \ifvmode |
---|
3281 | \dosubindsanitize |
---|
3282 | \else |
---|
3283 | \dosubindwrite |
---|
3284 | \fi |
---|
3285 | }% |
---|
3286 | \fi |
---|
3287 | } |
---|
3288 | |
---|
3289 | % Write the entry in \toks0 to the index file: |
---|
3290 | % |
---|
3291 | \def\dosubindwrite{% |
---|
3292 | % Put the index entry in the margin if desired. |
---|
3293 | \ifx\SETmarginindex\relax\else |
---|
3294 | \insert\margin{\hbox{\vrule height8pt depth3pt width0pt \the\toks0}}% |
---|
3295 | \fi |
---|
3296 | % |
---|
3297 | % Remember, we are within a group. |
---|
3298 | \indexdummies % Must do this here, since \bf, etc expand at this stage |
---|
3299 | \escapechar=`\\ |
---|
3300 | \def\backslashcurfont{\indexbackslash}% \indexbackslash isn't defined now |
---|
3301 | % so it will be output as is; and it will print as backslash. |
---|
3302 | % |
---|
3303 | % Process the index entry with all font commands turned off, to |
---|
3304 | % get the string to sort by. |
---|
3305 | {\indexnofonts |
---|
3306 | \edef\temp{\the\toks0}% need full expansion |
---|
3307 | \xdef\indexsorttmp{\temp}% |
---|
3308 | }% |
---|
3309 | % |
---|
3310 | % Set up the complete index entry, with both the sort key and |
---|
3311 | % the original text, including any font commands. We write |
---|
3312 | % three arguments to \entry to the .?? file (four in the |
---|
3313 | % subentry case), texindex reduces to two when writing the .??s |
---|
3314 | % sorted result. |
---|
3315 | \edef\temp{% |
---|
3316 | \write\writeto{% |
---|
3317 | \string\entry{\indexsorttmp}{\noexpand\folio}{\the\toks0}}% |
---|
3318 | }% |
---|
3319 | \temp |
---|
3320 | } |
---|
3321 | |
---|
3322 | % Take care of unwanted page breaks: |
---|
3323 | % |
---|
3324 | % If a skip is the last thing on the list now, preserve it |
---|
3325 | % by backing up by \lastskip, doing the \write, then inserting |
---|
3326 | % the skip again. Otherwise, the whatsit generated by the |
---|
3327 | % \write will make \lastskip zero. The result is that sequences |
---|
3328 | % like this: |
---|
3329 | % @end defun |
---|
3330 | % @tindex whatever |
---|
3331 | % @defun ... |
---|
3332 | % will have extra space inserted, because the \medbreak in the |
---|
3333 | % start of the @defun won't see the skip inserted by the @end of |
---|
3334 | % the previous defun. |
---|
3335 | % |
---|
3336 | % But don't do any of this if we're not in vertical mode. We |
---|
3337 | % don't want to do a \vskip and prematurely end a paragraph. |
---|
3338 | % |
---|
3339 | % Avoid page breaks due to these extra skips, too. |
---|
3340 | % |
---|
3341 | % But wait, there is a catch there: |
---|
3342 | % We'll have to check whether \lastskip is zero skip. \ifdim is not |
---|
3343 | % sufficient for this purpose, as it ignores stretch and shrink parts |
---|
3344 | % of the skip. The only way seems to be to check the textual |
---|
3345 | % representation of the skip. |
---|
3346 | % |
---|
3347 | % The following is almost like \def\zeroskipmacro{0.0pt} except that |
---|
3348 | % the ``p'' and ``t'' characters have catcode \other, not 11 (letter). |
---|
3349 | % |
---|
3350 | \edef\zeroskipmacro{\expandafter\the\csname z@skip\endcsname} |
---|
3351 | % |
---|
3352 | % ..., ready, GO: |
---|
3353 | % |
---|
3354 | \def\dosubindsanitize{% |
---|
3355 | % \lastskip and \lastpenalty cannot both be nonzero simultaneously. |
---|
3356 | \skip0 = \lastskip |
---|
3357 | \edef\lastskipmacro{\the\lastskip}% |
---|
3358 | \count255 = \lastpenalty |
---|
3359 | % |
---|
3360 | % If \lastskip is nonzero, that means the last item was a |
---|
3361 | % skip. And since a skip is discardable, that means this |
---|
3362 | % -\skip0 glue we're inserting is preceded by a |
---|
3363 | % non-discardable item, therefore it is not a potential |
---|
3364 | % breakpoint, therefore no \nobreak needed. |
---|
3365 | \ifx\lastskipmacro\zeroskipmacro |
---|
3366 | \else |
---|
3367 | \vskip-\skip0 |
---|
3368 | \fi |
---|
3369 | % |
---|
3370 | \dosubindwrite |
---|
3371 | % |
---|
3372 | \ifx\lastskipmacro\zeroskipmacro |
---|
3373 | % if \lastskip was zero, perhaps the last item was a |
---|
3374 | % penalty, and perhaps it was >=10000, e.g., a \nobreak. |
---|
3375 | % In that case, we want to re-insert the penalty; since we |
---|
3376 | % just inserted a non-discardable item, any following glue |
---|
3377 | % (such as a \parskip) would be a breakpoint. For example: |
---|
3378 | % @deffn deffn-whatever |
---|
3379 | % @vindex index-whatever |
---|
3380 | % Description. |
---|
3381 | % would allow a break between the index-whatever whatsit |
---|
3382 | % and the "Description." paragraph. |
---|
3383 | \ifnum\count255>9999 \nobreak \fi |
---|
3384 | \else |
---|
3385 | % On the other hand, if we had a nonzero \lastskip, |
---|
3386 | % this make-up glue would be preceded by a non-discardable item |
---|
3387 | % (the whatsit from the \write), so we must insert a \nobreak. |
---|
3388 | \nobreak\vskip\skip0 |
---|
3389 | \fi |
---|
3390 | } |
---|
3391 | |
---|
3392 | % The index entry written in the file actually looks like |
---|
3393 | % \entry {sortstring}{page}{topic} |
---|
3394 | % or |
---|
3395 | % \entry {sortstring}{page}{topic}{subtopic} |
---|
3396 | % The texindex program reads in these files and writes files |
---|
3397 | % containing these kinds of lines: |
---|
3398 | % \initial {c} |
---|
3399 | % before the first topic whose initial is c |
---|
3400 | % \entry {topic}{pagelist} |
---|
3401 | % for a topic that is used without subtopics |
---|
3402 | % \primary {topic} |
---|
3403 | % for the beginning of a topic that is used with subtopics |
---|
3404 | % \secondary {subtopic}{pagelist} |
---|
3405 | % for each subtopic. |
---|
3406 | |
---|
3407 | % Define the user-accessible indexing commands |
---|
3408 | % @findex, @vindex, @kindex, @cindex. |
---|
3409 | |
---|
3410 | \def\findex {\fnindex} |
---|
3411 | \def\kindex {\kyindex} |
---|
3412 | \def\cindex {\cpindex} |
---|
3413 | \def\vindex {\vrindex} |
---|
3414 | \def\tindex {\tpindex} |
---|
3415 | \def\pindex {\pgindex} |
---|
3416 | |
---|
3417 | \def\cindexsub {\begingroup\obeylines\cindexsub} |
---|
3418 | {\obeylines % |
---|
3419 | \gdef\cindexsub "#1" #2^^M{\endgroup % |
---|
3420 | \dosubind{cp}{#2}{#1}}} |
---|
3421 | |
---|
3422 | % Define the macros used in formatting output of the sorted index material. |
---|
3423 | |
---|
3424 | % @printindex causes a particular index (the ??s file) to get printed. |
---|
3425 | % It does not print any chapter heading (usually an @unnumbered). |
---|
3426 | % |
---|
3427 | \parseargdef\printindex{\begingroup |
---|
3428 | \dobreak \chapheadingskip{10000}% |
---|
3429 | % |
---|
3430 | \smallfonts \rm |
---|
3431 | \tolerance = 9500 |
---|
3432 | \everypar = {}% don't want the \kern\-parindent from indentation suppression. |
---|
3433 | % |
---|
3434 | % See if the index file exists and is nonempty. |
---|
3435 | % Change catcode of @ here so that if the index file contains |
---|
3436 | % \initial {@} |
---|
3437 | % as its first line, TeX doesn't complain about mismatched braces |
---|
3438 | % (because it thinks @} is a control sequence). |
---|
3439 | \catcode`\@ = 11 |
---|
3440 | \openin 1 \jobname.#1s |
---|
3441 | \ifeof 1 |
---|
3442 | % \enddoublecolumns gets confused if there is no text in the index, |
---|
3443 | % and it loses the chapter title and the aux file entries for the |
---|
3444 | % index. The easiest way to prevent this problem is to make sure |
---|
3445 | % there is some text. |
---|
3446 | \putwordIndexNonexistent |
---|
3447 | \else |
---|
3448 | % |
---|
3449 | % If the index file exists but is empty, then \openin leaves \ifeof |
---|
3450 | % false. We have to make TeX try to read something from the file, so |
---|
3451 | % it can discover if there is anything in it. |
---|
3452 | \read 1 to \temp |
---|
3453 | \ifeof 1 |
---|
3454 | \putwordIndexIsEmpty |
---|
3455 | \else |
---|
3456 | % Index files are almost Texinfo source, but we use \ as the escape |
---|
3457 | % character. It would be better to use @, but that's too big a change |
---|
3458 | % to make right now. |
---|
3459 | \def\indexbackslash{\backslashcurfont}% |
---|
3460 | \catcode`\\ = 0 |
---|
3461 | \escapechar = `\\ |
---|
3462 | \begindoublecolumns |
---|
3463 | \input \jobname.#1s |
---|
3464 | \enddoublecolumns |
---|
3465 | \fi |
---|
3466 | \fi |
---|
3467 | \closein 1 |
---|
3468 | \endgroup} |
---|
3469 | |
---|
3470 | % These macros are used by the sorted index file itself. |
---|
3471 | % Change them to control the appearance of the index. |
---|
3472 | |
---|
3473 | \def\initial#1{{% |
---|
3474 | % Some minor font changes for the special characters. |
---|
3475 | \let\tentt=\sectt \let\tt=\sectt \let\sf=\sectt |
---|
3476 | % |
---|
3477 | % Remove any glue we may have, we'll be inserting our own. |
---|
3478 | \removelastskip |
---|
3479 | % |
---|
3480 | % We like breaks before the index initials, so insert a bonus. |
---|
3481 | \penalty -300 |
---|
3482 | % |
---|
3483 | % Typeset the initial. Making this add up to a whole number of |
---|
3484 | % baselineskips increases the chance of the dots lining up from column |
---|
3485 | % to column. It still won't often be perfect, because of the stretch |
---|
3486 | % we need before each entry, but it's better. |
---|
3487 | % |
---|
3488 | % No shrink because it confuses \balancecolumns. |
---|
3489 | \vskip 1.67\baselineskip plus .5\baselineskip |
---|
3490 | \leftline{\secbf #1}% |
---|
3491 | \vskip .33\baselineskip plus .1\baselineskip |
---|
3492 | % |
---|
3493 | % Do our best not to break after the initial. |
---|
3494 | \nobreak |
---|
3495 | }} |
---|
3496 | |
---|
3497 | % \entry typesets a paragraph consisting of the text (#1), dot leaders, and |
---|
3498 | % then page number (#2) flushed to the right margin. It is used for index |
---|
3499 | % and table of contents entries. The paragraph is indented by \leftskip. |
---|
3500 | % |
---|
3501 | % A straightforward implementation would start like this: |
---|
3502 | % \def\entry#1#2{... |
---|
3503 | % But this frozes the catcodes in the argument, and can cause problems to |
---|
3504 | % @code, which sets - active. This problem was fixed by a kludge--- |
---|
3505 | % ``-'' was active throughout whole index, but this isn't really right. |
---|
3506 | % |
---|
3507 | % The right solution is to prevent \entry from swallowing the whole text. |
---|
3508 | % --kasal, 21nov03 |
---|
3509 | \def\entry{% |
---|
3510 | \begingroup |
---|
3511 | % |
---|
3512 | % Start a new paragraph if necessary, so our assignments below can't |
---|
3513 | % affect previous text. |
---|
3514 | \par |
---|
3515 | % |
---|
3516 | % Do not fill out the last line with white space. |
---|
3517 | \parfillskip = 0in |
---|
3518 | % |
---|
3519 | % No extra space above this paragraph. |
---|
3520 | \parskip = 0in |
---|
3521 | % |
---|
3522 | % Do not prefer a separate line ending with a hyphen to fewer lines. |
---|
3523 | \finalhyphendemerits = 0 |
---|
3524 | % |
---|
3525 | % \hangindent is only relevant when the entry text and page number |
---|
3526 | % don't both fit on one line. In that case, bob suggests starting the |
---|
3527 | % dots pretty far over on the line. Unfortunately, a large |
---|
3528 | % indentation looks wrong when the entry text itself is broken across |
---|
3529 | % lines. So we use a small indentation and put up with long leaders. |
---|
3530 | % |
---|
3531 | % \hangafter is reset to 1 (which is the value we want) at the start |
---|
3532 | % of each paragraph, so we need not do anything with that. |
---|
3533 | \hangindent = 2em |
---|
3534 | % |
---|
3535 | % When the entry text needs to be broken, just fill out the first line |
---|
3536 | % with blank space. |
---|
3537 | \rightskip = 0pt plus1fil |
---|
3538 | % |
---|
3539 | % A bit of stretch before each entry for the benefit of balancing |
---|
3540 | % columns. |
---|
3541 | \vskip 0pt plus1pt |
---|
3542 | % |
---|
3543 | % Swallow the left brace of the text (first parameter): |
---|
3544 | \afterassignment\doentry |
---|
3545 | \let\temp = |
---|
3546 | } |
---|
3547 | \def\doentry{% |
---|
3548 | \bgroup % Instead of the swallowed brace. |
---|
3549 | \noindent |
---|
3550 | \aftergroup\finishentry |
---|
3551 | % And now comes the text of the entry. |
---|
3552 | } |
---|
3553 | \def\finishentry#1{% |
---|
3554 | % #1 is the page number. |
---|
3555 | % |
---|
3556 | % The following is kludged to not output a line of dots in the index if |
---|
3557 | % there are no page numbers. The next person who breaks this will be |
---|
3558 | % cursed by a Unix daemon. |
---|
3559 | \def\tempa{{\rm }}% |
---|
3560 | \def\tempb{#1}% |
---|
3561 | \edef\tempc{\tempa}% |
---|
3562 | \edef\tempd{\tempb}% |
---|
3563 | \ifx\tempc\tempd |
---|
3564 | \ % |
---|
3565 | \else |
---|
3566 | % |
---|
3567 | % If we must, put the page number on a line of its own, and fill out |
---|
3568 | % this line with blank space. (The \hfil is overwhelmed with the |
---|
3569 | % fill leaders glue in \indexdotfill if the page number does fit.) |
---|
3570 | \hfil\penalty50 |
---|
3571 | \null\nobreak\indexdotfill % Have leaders before the page number. |
---|
3572 | % |
---|
3573 | % The `\ ' here is removed by the implicit \unskip that TeX does as |
---|
3574 | % part of (the primitive) \par. Without it, a spurious underfull |
---|
3575 | % \hbox ensues. |
---|
3576 | \ifpdf |
---|
3577 | \pdfgettoks#1.% |
---|
3578 | \ \the\toksA |
---|
3579 | \else |
---|
3580 | \ #1% |
---|
3581 | \fi |
---|
3582 | \fi |
---|
3583 | \par |
---|
3584 | \endgroup |
---|
3585 | } |
---|
3586 | |
---|
3587 | % Like \dotfill except takes at least 1 em. |
---|
3588 | \def\indexdotfill{\cleaders |
---|
3589 | \hbox{$\mathsurround=0pt \mkern1.5mu ${\it .}$ \mkern1.5mu$}\hskip 1em plus 1fill} |
---|
3590 | |
---|
3591 | \def\primary #1{\line{#1\hfil}} |
---|
3592 | |
---|
3593 | \newskip\secondaryindent \secondaryindent=0.5cm |
---|
3594 | \def\secondary#1#2{{% |
---|
3595 | \parfillskip=0in |
---|
3596 | \parskip=0in |
---|
3597 | \hangindent=1in |
---|
3598 | \hangafter=1 |
---|
3599 | \noindent\hskip\secondaryindent\hbox{#1}\indexdotfill |
---|
3600 | \ifpdf |
---|
3601 | \pdfgettoks#2.\ \the\toksA % The page number ends the paragraph. |
---|
3602 | \else |
---|
3603 | #2 |
---|
3604 | \fi |
---|
3605 | \par |
---|
3606 | }} |
---|
3607 | |
---|
3608 | % Define two-column mode, which we use to typeset indexes. |
---|
3609 | % Adapted from the TeXbook, page 416, which is to say, |
---|
3610 | % the manmac.tex format used to print the TeXbook itself. |
---|
3611 | \catcode`\@=11 |
---|
3612 | |
---|
3613 | \newbox\partialpage |
---|
3614 | \newdimen\doublecolumnhsize |
---|
3615 | |
---|
3616 | \def\begindoublecolumns{\begingroup % ended by \enddoublecolumns |
---|
3617 | % Grab any single-column material above us. |
---|
3618 | \output = {% |
---|
3619 | % |
---|
3620 | % Here is a possibility not foreseen in manmac: if we accumulate a |
---|
3621 | % whole lot of material, we might end up calling this \output |
---|
3622 | % routine twice in a row (see the doublecol-lose test, which is |
---|
3623 | % essentially a couple of indexes with @setchapternewpage off). In |
---|
3624 | % that case we just ship out what is in \partialpage with the normal |
---|
3625 | % output routine. Generally, \partialpage will be empty when this |
---|
3626 | % runs and this will be a no-op. See the indexspread.tex test case. |
---|
3627 | \ifvoid\partialpage \else |
---|
3628 | \onepageout{\pagecontents\partialpage}% |
---|
3629 | \fi |
---|
3630 | % |
---|
3631 | \global\setbox\partialpage = \vbox{% |
---|
3632 | % Unvbox the main output page. |
---|
3633 | \unvbox\PAGE |
---|
3634 | \kern-\topskip \kern\baselineskip |
---|
3635 | }% |
---|
3636 | }% |
---|
3637 | \eject % run that output routine to set \partialpage |
---|
3638 | % |
---|
3639 | % Use the double-column output routine for subsequent pages. |
---|
3640 | \output = {\doublecolumnout}% |
---|
3641 | % |
---|
3642 | % Change the page size parameters. We could do this once outside this |
---|
3643 | % routine, in each of @smallbook, @afourpaper, and the default 8.5x11 |
---|
3644 | % format, but then we repeat the same computation. Repeating a couple |
---|
3645 | % of assignments once per index is clearly meaningless for the |
---|
3646 | % execution time, so we may as well do it in one place. |
---|
3647 | % |
---|
3648 | % First we halve the line length, less a little for the gutter between |
---|
3649 | % the columns. We compute the gutter based on the line length, so it |
---|
3650 | % changes automatically with the paper format. The magic constant |
---|
3651 | % below is chosen so that the gutter has the same value (well, +-<1pt) |
---|
3652 | % as it did when we hard-coded it. |
---|
3653 | % |
---|
3654 | % We put the result in a separate register, \doublecolumhsize, so we |
---|
3655 | % can restore it in \pagesofar, after \hsize itself has (potentially) |
---|
3656 | % been clobbered. |
---|
3657 | % |
---|
3658 | \doublecolumnhsize = \hsize |
---|
3659 | \advance\doublecolumnhsize by -.04154\hsize |
---|
3660 | \divide\doublecolumnhsize by 2 |
---|
3661 | \hsize = \doublecolumnhsize |
---|
3662 | % |
---|
3663 | % Double the \vsize as well. (We don't need a separate register here, |
---|
3664 | % since nobody clobbers \vsize.) |
---|
3665 | \vsize = 2\vsize |
---|
3666 | } |
---|
3667 | |
---|
3668 | % The double-column output routine for all double-column pages except |
---|
3669 | % the last. |
---|
3670 | % |
---|
3671 | \def\doublecolumnout{% |
---|
3672 | \splittopskip=\topskip \splitmaxdepth=\maxdepth |
---|
3673 | % Get the available space for the double columns -- the normal |
---|
3674 | % (undoubled) page height minus any material left over from the |
---|
3675 | % previous page. |
---|
3676 | \dimen@ = \vsize |
---|
3677 | \divide\dimen@ by 2 |
---|
3678 | \advance\dimen@ by -\ht\partialpage |
---|
3679 | % |
---|
3680 | % box0 will be the left-hand column, box2 the right. |
---|
3681 | \setbox0=\vsplit255 to\dimen@ \setbox2=\vsplit255 to\dimen@ |
---|
3682 | \onepageout\pagesofar |
---|
3683 | \unvbox255 |
---|
3684 | \penalty\outputpenalty |
---|
3685 | } |
---|
3686 | % |
---|
3687 | % Re-output the contents of the output page -- any previous material, |
---|
3688 | % followed by the two boxes we just split, in box0 and box2. |
---|
3689 | \def\pagesofar{% |
---|
3690 | \unvbox\partialpage |
---|
3691 | % |
---|
3692 | \hsize = \doublecolumnhsize |
---|
3693 | \wd0=\hsize \wd2=\hsize |
---|
3694 | \hbox to\pagewidth{\box0\hfil\box2}% |
---|
3695 | } |
---|
3696 | % |
---|
3697 | % All done with double columns. |
---|
3698 | \def\enddoublecolumns{% |
---|
3699 | \output = {% |
---|
3700 | % Split the last of the double-column material. Leave it on the |
---|
3701 | % current page, no automatic page break. |
---|
3702 | \balancecolumns |
---|
3703 | % |
---|
3704 | % If we end up splitting too much material for the current page, |
---|
3705 | % though, there will be another page break right after this \output |
---|
3706 | % invocation ends. Having called \balancecolumns once, we do not |
---|
3707 | % want to call it again. Therefore, reset \output to its normal |
---|
3708 | % definition right away. (We hope \balancecolumns will never be |
---|
3709 | % called on to balance too much material, but if it is, this makes |
---|
3710 | % the output somewhat more palatable.) |
---|
3711 | \global\output = {\onepageout{\pagecontents\PAGE}}% |
---|
3712 | }% |
---|
3713 | \eject |
---|
3714 | \endgroup % started in \begindoublecolumns |
---|
3715 | % |
---|
3716 | % \pagegoal was set to the doubled \vsize above, since we restarted |
---|
3717 | % the current page. We're now back to normal single-column |
---|
3718 | % typesetting, so reset \pagegoal to the normal \vsize (after the |
---|
3719 | % \endgroup where \vsize got restored). |
---|
3720 | \pagegoal = \vsize |
---|
3721 | } |
---|
3722 | % |
---|
3723 | % Called at the end of the double column material. |
---|
3724 | \def\balancecolumns{% |
---|
3725 | \setbox0 = \vbox{\unvbox255}% like \box255 but more efficient, see p.120. |
---|
3726 | \dimen@ = \ht0 |
---|
3727 | \advance\dimen@ by \topskip |
---|
3728 | \advance\dimen@ by-\baselineskip |
---|
3729 | \divide\dimen@ by 2 % target to split to |
---|
3730 | %debug\message{final 2-column material height=\the\ht0, target=\the\dimen@.}% |
---|
3731 | \splittopskip = \topskip |
---|
3732 | % Loop until we get a decent breakpoint. |
---|
3733 | {% |
---|
3734 | \vbadness = 10000 |
---|
3735 | \loop |
---|
3736 | \global\setbox3 = \copy0 |
---|
3737 | \global\setbox1 = \vsplit3 to \dimen@ |
---|
3738 | \ifdim\ht3>\dimen@ |
---|
3739 | \global\advance\dimen@ by 1pt |
---|
3740 | \repeat |
---|
3741 | }% |
---|
3742 | %debug\message{split to \the\dimen@, column heights: \the\ht1, \the\ht3.}% |
---|
3743 | \setbox0=\vbox to\dimen@{\unvbox1}% |
---|
3744 | \setbox2=\vbox to\dimen@{\unvbox3}% |
---|
3745 | % |
---|
3746 | \pagesofar |
---|
3747 | } |
---|
3748 | \catcode`\@ = \other |
---|
3749 | |
---|
3750 | |
---|
3751 | \message{sectioning,} |
---|
3752 | % Chapters, sections, etc. |
---|
3753 | |
---|
3754 | % \unnumberedno is an oxymoron, of course. But we count the unnumbered |
---|
3755 | % sections so that we can refer to them unambiguously in the pdf |
---|
3756 | % outlines by their "section number". We avoid collisions with chapter |
---|
3757 | % numbers by starting them at 10000. (If a document ever has 10000 |
---|
3758 | % chapters, we're in trouble anyway, I'm sure.) |
---|
3759 | \newcount\unnumberedno \unnumberedno = 10000 |
---|
3760 | \newcount\chapno |
---|
3761 | \newcount\secno \secno=0 |
---|
3762 | \newcount\subsecno \subsecno=0 |
---|
3763 | \newcount\subsubsecno \subsubsecno=0 |
---|
3764 | |
---|
3765 | % This counter is funny since it counts through charcodes of letters A, B, ... |
---|
3766 | \newcount\appendixno \appendixno = `\@ |
---|
3767 | % |
---|
3768 | % \def\appendixletter{\char\the\appendixno} |
---|
3769 | % We do the following ugly conditional instead of the above simple |
---|
3770 | % construct for the sake of pdftex, which needs the actual |
---|
3771 | % letter in the expansion, not just typeset. |
---|
3772 | % |
---|
3773 | \def\appendixletter{% |
---|
3774 | \ifnum\appendixno=`A A% |
---|
3775 | \else\ifnum\appendixno=`B B% |
---|
3776 | \else\ifnum\appendixno=`C C% |
---|
3777 | \else\ifnum\appendixno=`D D% |
---|
3778 | \else\ifnum\appendixno=`E E% |
---|
3779 | \else\ifnum\appendixno=`F F% |
---|
3780 | \else\ifnum\appendixno=`G G% |
---|
3781 | \else\ifnum\appendixno=`H H% |
---|
3782 | \else\ifnum\appendixno=`I I% |
---|
3783 | \else\ifnum\appendixno=`J J% |
---|
3784 | \else\ifnum\appendixno=`K K% |
---|
3785 | \else\ifnum\appendixno=`L L% |
---|
3786 | \else\ifnum\appendixno=`M M% |
---|
3787 | \else\ifnum\appendixno=`N N% |
---|
3788 | \else\ifnum\appendixno=`O O% |
---|
3789 | \else\ifnum\appendixno=`P P% |
---|
3790 | \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Q Q% |
---|
3791 | \else\ifnum\appendixno=`R R% |
---|
3792 | \else\ifnum\appendixno=`S S% |
---|
3793 | \else\ifnum\appendixno=`T T% |
---|
3794 | \else\ifnum\appendixno=`U U% |
---|
3795 | \else\ifnum\appendixno=`V V% |
---|
3796 | \else\ifnum\appendixno=`W W% |
---|
3797 | \else\ifnum\appendixno=`X X% |
---|
3798 | \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Y Y% |
---|
3799 | \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Z Z% |
---|
3800 | % The \the is necessary, despite appearances, because \appendixletter is |
---|
3801 | % expanded while writing the .toc file. \char\appendixno is not |
---|
3802 | % expandable, thus it is written literally, thus all appendixes come out |
---|
3803 | % with the same letter (or @) in the toc without it. |
---|
3804 | \else\char\the\appendixno |
---|
3805 | \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi |
---|
3806 | \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi} |
---|
3807 | |
---|
3808 | % Each @chapter defines this as the name of the chapter. |
---|
3809 | % page headings and footings can use it. @section does likewise. |
---|
3810 | % However, they are not reliable, because we don't use marks. |
---|
3811 | \def\thischapter{} |
---|
3812 | \def\thissection{} |
---|
3813 | |
---|
3814 | \newcount\absseclevel % used to calculate proper heading level |
---|
3815 | \newcount\secbase\secbase=0 % @raisesections/@lowersections modify this count |
---|
3816 | |
---|
3817 | % @raisesections: treat @section as chapter, @subsection as section, etc. |
---|
3818 | \def\raisesections{\global\advance\secbase by -1} |
---|
3819 | \let\up=\raisesections % original BFox name |
---|
3820 | |
---|
3821 | % @lowersections: treat @chapter as section, @section as subsection, etc. |
---|
3822 | \def\lowersections{\global\advance\secbase by 1} |
---|
3823 | \let\down=\lowersections % original BFox name |
---|
3824 | |
---|
3825 | % we only have subsub. |
---|
3826 | \chardef\maxseclevel = 3 |
---|
3827 | % |
---|
3828 | % A numbered section within an unnumbered changes to unnumbered too. |
---|
3829 | % To achive this, remember the "biggest" unnum. sec. we are currently in: |
---|
3830 | \chardef\unmlevel = \maxseclevel |
---|
3831 | % |
---|
3832 | % Trace whether the current chapter is an appendix or not: |
---|
3833 | % \chapheadtype is "N" or "A", unnumbered chapters are ignored. |
---|
3834 | \def\chapheadtype{N} |
---|
3835 | |
---|
3836 | % Choose a heading macro |
---|
3837 | % #1 is heading type |
---|
3838 | % #2 is heading level |
---|
3839 | % #3 is text for heading |
---|
3840 | \def\genhead#1#2#3{% |
---|
3841 | % Compute the abs. sec. level: |
---|
3842 | \absseclevel=#2 |
---|
3843 | \advance\absseclevel by \secbase |
---|
3844 | % Make sure \absseclevel doesn't fall outside the range: |
---|
3845 | \ifnum \absseclevel < 0 |
---|
3846 | \absseclevel = 0 |
---|
3847 | \else |
---|
3848 | \ifnum \absseclevel > 3 |
---|
3849 | \absseclevel = 3 |
---|
3850 | \fi |
---|
3851 | \fi |
---|
3852 | % The heading type: |
---|
3853 | \def\headtype{#1}% |
---|
3854 | \if \headtype U% |
---|
3855 | \ifnum \absseclevel < \unmlevel |
---|
3856 | \chardef\unmlevel = \absseclevel |
---|
3857 | \fi |
---|
3858 | \else |
---|
3859 | % Check for appendix sections: |
---|
3860 | \ifnum \absseclevel = 0 |
---|
3861 | \edef\chapheadtype{\headtype}% |
---|
3862 | \else |
---|
3863 | \if \headtype A\if \chapheadtype N% |
---|
3864 | \errmessage{@appendix... within a non-appendix chapter}% |
---|
3865 | \fi\fi |
---|
3866 | \fi |
---|
3867 | % Check for numbered within unnumbered: |
---|
3868 | \ifnum \absseclevel > \unmlevel |
---|
3869 | \def\headtype{U}% |
---|
3870 | \else |
---|
3871 | \chardef\unmlevel = 3 |
---|
3872 | \fi |
---|
3873 | \fi |
---|
3874 | % Now print the heading: |
---|
3875 | \if \headtype U% |
---|
3876 | \ifcase\absseclevel |
---|
3877 | \unnumberedzzz{#3}% |
---|
3878 | \or \unnumberedseczzz{#3}% |
---|
3879 | \or \unnumberedsubseczzz{#3}% |
---|
3880 | \or \unnumberedsubsubseczzz{#3}% |
---|
3881 | \fi |
---|
3882 | \else |
---|
3883 | \if \headtype A% |
---|
3884 | \ifcase\absseclevel |
---|
3885 | \appendixzzz{#3}% |
---|
3886 | \or \appendixsectionzzz{#3}% |
---|
3887 | \or \appendixsubseczzz{#3}% |
---|
3888 | \or \appendixsubsubseczzz{#3}% |
---|
3889 | \fi |
---|
3890 | \else |
---|
3891 | \ifcase\absseclevel |
---|
3892 | \chapterzzz{#3}% |
---|
3893 | \or \seczzz{#3}% |
---|
3894 | \or \numberedsubseczzz{#3}% |
---|
3895 | \or \numberedsubsubseczzz{#3}% |
---|
3896 | \fi |
---|
3897 | \fi |
---|
3898 | \fi |
---|
3899 | \suppressfirstparagraphindent |
---|
3900 | } |
---|
3901 | |
---|
3902 | % an interface: |
---|
3903 | \def\numhead{\genhead N} |
---|
3904 | \def\apphead{\genhead A} |
---|
3905 | \def\unnmhead{\genhead U} |
---|
3906 | |
---|
3907 | % @chapter, @appendix, @unnumbered. Increment top-level counter, reset |
---|
3908 | % all lower-level sectioning counters to zero. |
---|
3909 | % |
---|
3910 | % Also set \chaplevelprefix, which we prepend to @float sequence numbers |
---|
3911 | % (e.g., figures), q.v. By default (before any chapter), that is empty. |
---|
3912 | \let\chaplevelprefix = \empty |
---|
3913 | % |
---|
3914 | \outer\parseargdef\chapter{\numhead0{#1}} % normally numhead0 calls chapterzzz |
---|
3915 | \def\chapterzzz#1{% |
---|
3916 | % section resetting is \global in case the chapter is in a group, such |
---|
3917 | % as an @include file. |
---|
3918 | \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 |
---|
3919 | \global\advance\chapno by 1 |
---|
3920 | % |
---|
3921 | % Used for \float. |
---|
3922 | \gdef\chaplevelprefix{\the\chapno.}% |
---|
3923 | \resetallfloatnos |
---|
3924 | % |
---|
3925 | \message{\putwordChapter\space \the\chapno}% |
---|
3926 | % |
---|
3927 | % Write the actual heading. |
---|
3928 | \chapmacro{#1}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno}% |
---|
3929 | % |
---|
3930 | % So @section and the like are numbered underneath this chapter. |
---|
3931 | \global\let\section = \numberedsec |
---|
3932 | \global\let\subsection = \numberedsubsec |
---|
3933 | \global\let\subsubsection = \numberedsubsubsec |
---|
3934 | } |
---|
3935 | |
---|
3936 | \outer\parseargdef\appendix{\apphead0{#1}} % normally apphead0 calls appendixzzz |
---|
3937 | \def\appendixzzz#1{% |
---|
3938 | \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 |
---|
3939 | \global\advance\appendixno by 1 |
---|
3940 | \gdef\chaplevelprefix{\appendixletter.}% |
---|
3941 | \resetallfloatnos |
---|
3942 | % |
---|
3943 | \def\appendixnum{\putwordAppendix\space \appendixletter}% |
---|
3944 | \message{\appendixnum}% |
---|
3945 | % |
---|
3946 | \chapmacro{#1}{Yappendix}{\appendixletter}% |
---|
3947 | % |
---|
3948 | \global\let\section = \appendixsec |
---|
3949 | \global\let\subsection = \appendixsubsec |
---|
3950 | \global\let\subsubsection = \appendixsubsubsec |
---|
3951 | } |
---|
3952 | |
---|
3953 | \outer\parseargdef\unnumbered{\unnmhead0{#1}} % normally unnmhead0 calls unnumberedzzz |
---|
3954 | \def\unnumberedzzz#1{% |
---|
3955 | \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 |
---|
3956 | \global\advance\unnumberedno by 1 |
---|
3957 | % |
---|
3958 | % Since an unnumbered has no number, no prefix for figures. |
---|
3959 | \global\let\chaplevelprefix = \empty |
---|
3960 | \resetallfloatnos |
---|
3961 | % |
---|
3962 | % This used to be simply \message{#1}, but TeX fully expands the |
---|
3963 | % argument to \message. Therefore, if #1 contained @-commands, TeX |
---|
3964 | % expanded them. For example, in `@unnumbered The @cite{Book}', TeX |
---|
3965 | % expanded @cite (which turns out to cause errors because \cite is meant |
---|
3966 | % to be executed, not expanded). |
---|
3967 | % |
---|
3968 | % Anyway, we don't want the fully-expanded definition of @cite to appear |
---|
3969 | % as a result of the \message, we just want `@cite' itself. We use |
---|
3970 | % \the<toks register> to achieve this: TeX expands \the<toks> only once, |
---|
3971 | % simply yielding the contents of <toks register>. (We also do this for |
---|
3972 | % the toc entries.) |
---|
3973 | \toks0 = {#1}% |
---|
3974 | \message{(\the\toks0)}% |
---|
3975 | % |
---|
3976 | \chapmacro{#1}{Ynothing}{\the\unnumberedno}% |
---|
3977 | % |
---|
3978 | \global\let\section = \unnumberedsec |
---|
3979 | \global\let\subsection = \unnumberedsubsec |
---|
3980 | \global\let\subsubsection = \unnumberedsubsubsec |
---|
3981 | } |
---|
3982 | |
---|
3983 | % @centerchap is like @unnumbered, but the heading is centered. |
---|
3984 | \outer\parseargdef\centerchap{% |
---|
3985 | % Well, we could do the following in a group, but that would break |
---|
3986 | % an assumption that \chapmacro is called at the outermost level. |
---|
3987 | % Thus we are safer this way: --kasal, 24feb04 |
---|
3988 | \let\centerparametersmaybe = \centerparameters |
---|
3989 | \unnmhead0{#1}% |
---|
3990 | \let\centerparametersmaybe = \relax |
---|
3991 | } |
---|
3992 | |
---|
3993 | % @top is like @unnumbered. |
---|
3994 | \let\top\unnumbered |
---|
3995 | |
---|
3996 | % Sections. |
---|
3997 | \outer\parseargdef\numberedsec{\numhead1{#1}} % normally calls seczzz |
---|
3998 | \def\seczzz#1{% |
---|
3999 | \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\secno by 1 |
---|
4000 | \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno.\the\secno}% |
---|
4001 | } |
---|
4002 | |
---|
4003 | \outer\parseargdef\appendixsection{\apphead1{#1}} % normally calls appendixsectionzzz |
---|
4004 | \def\appendixsectionzzz#1{% |
---|
4005 | \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\secno by 1 |
---|
4006 | \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Yappendix}{\appendixletter.\the\secno}% |
---|
4007 | } |
---|
4008 | \let\appendixsec\appendixsection |
---|
4009 | |
---|
4010 | \outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsec{\unnmhead1{#1}} % normally calls unnumberedseczzz |
---|
4011 | \def\unnumberedseczzz#1{% |
---|
4012 | \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\secno by 1 |
---|
4013 | \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Ynothing}{\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno}% |
---|
4014 | } |
---|
4015 | |
---|
4016 | % Subsections. |
---|
4017 | \outer\parseargdef\numberedsubsec{\numhead2{#1}} % normally calls numberedsubseczzz |
---|
4018 | \def\numberedsubseczzz#1{% |
---|
4019 | \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\subsecno by 1 |
---|
4020 | \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}% |
---|
4021 | } |
---|
4022 | |
---|
4023 | \outer\parseargdef\appendixsubsec{\apphead2{#1}} % normally calls appendixsubseczzz |
---|
4024 | \def\appendixsubseczzz#1{% |
---|
4025 | \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\subsecno by 1 |
---|
4026 | \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Yappendix}% |
---|
4027 | {\appendixletter.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}% |
---|
4028 | } |
---|
4029 | |
---|
4030 | \outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsubsec{\unnmhead2{#1}} %normally calls unnumberedsubseczzz |
---|
4031 | \def\unnumberedsubseczzz#1{% |
---|
4032 | \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\subsecno by 1 |
---|
4033 | \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Ynothing}% |
---|
4034 | {\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}% |
---|
4035 | } |
---|
4036 | |
---|
4037 | % Subsubsections. |
---|
4038 | \outer\parseargdef\numberedsubsubsec{\numhead3{#1}} % normally numberedsubsubseczzz |
---|
4039 | \def\numberedsubsubseczzz#1{% |
---|
4040 | \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1 |
---|
4041 | \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Ynumbered}% |
---|
4042 | {\the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}% |
---|
4043 | } |
---|
4044 | |
---|
4045 | \outer\parseargdef\appendixsubsubsec{\apphead3{#1}} % normally appendixsubsubseczzz |
---|
4046 | \def\appendixsubsubseczzz#1{% |
---|
4047 | \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1 |
---|
4048 | \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Yappendix}% |
---|
4049 | {\appendixletter.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}% |
---|
4050 | } |
---|
4051 | |
---|
4052 | \outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsubsubsec{\unnmhead3{#1}} %normally unnumberedsubsubseczzz |
---|
4053 | \def\unnumberedsubsubseczzz#1{% |
---|
4054 | \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1 |
---|
4055 | \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Ynothing}% |
---|
4056 | {\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}% |
---|
4057 | } |
---|
4058 | |
---|
4059 | % These macros control what the section commands do, according |
---|
4060 | % to what kind of chapter we are in (ordinary, appendix, or unnumbered). |
---|
4061 | % Define them by default for a numbered chapter. |
---|
4062 | \let\section = \numberedsec |
---|
4063 | \let\subsection = \numberedsubsec |
---|
4064 | \let\subsubsection = \numberedsubsubsec |
---|
4065 | |
---|
4066 | % Define @majorheading, @heading and @subheading |
---|
4067 | |
---|
4068 | % NOTE on use of \vbox for chapter headings, section headings, and such: |
---|
4069 | % 1) We use \vbox rather than the earlier \line to permit |
---|
4070 | % overlong headings to fold. |
---|
4071 | % 2) \hyphenpenalty is set to 10000 because hyphenation in a |
---|
4072 | % heading is obnoxious; this forbids it. |
---|
4073 | % 3) Likewise, headings look best if no \parindent is used, and |
---|
4074 | % if justification is not attempted. Hence \raggedright. |
---|
4075 | |
---|
4076 | |
---|
4077 | \def\majorheading{% |
---|
4078 | {\advance\chapheadingskip by 10pt \chapbreak }% |
---|
4079 | \parsearg\chapheadingzzz |
---|
4080 | } |
---|
4081 | |
---|
4082 | \def\chapheading{\chapbreak \parsearg\chapheadingzzz} |
---|
4083 | \def\chapheadingzzz#1{% |
---|
4084 | {\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000 |
---|
4085 | \parindent=0pt\raggedright |
---|
4086 | \rm #1\hfill}}% |
---|
4087 | \bigskip \par\penalty 200\relax |
---|
4088 | \suppressfirstparagraphindent |
---|
4089 | } |
---|
4090 | |
---|
4091 | % @heading, @subheading, @subsubheading. |
---|
4092 | \parseargdef\heading{\sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Yomitfromtoc}{} |
---|
4093 | \suppressfirstparagraphindent} |
---|
4094 | \parseargdef\subheading{\sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Yomitfromtoc}{} |
---|
4095 | \suppressfirstparagraphindent} |
---|
4096 | \parseargdef\subsubheading{\sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Yomitfromtoc}{} |
---|
4097 | \suppressfirstparagraphindent} |
---|
4098 | |
---|
4099 | % These macros generate a chapter, section, etc. heading only |
---|
4100 | % (including whitespace, linebreaking, etc. around it), |
---|
4101 | % given all the information in convenient, parsed form. |
---|
4102 | |
---|
4103 | %%% Args are the skip and penalty (usually negative) |
---|
4104 | \def\dobreak#1#2{\par\ifdim\lastskip<#1\removelastskip\penalty#2\vskip#1\fi} |
---|
4105 | |
---|
4106 | %%% Define plain chapter starts, and page on/off switching for it |
---|
4107 | % Parameter controlling skip before chapter headings (if needed) |
---|
4108 | |
---|
4109 | \newskip\chapheadingskip |
---|
4110 | |
---|
4111 | \def\chapbreak{\dobreak \chapheadingskip {-4000}} |
---|
4112 | \def\chappager{\par\vfill\supereject} |
---|
4113 | \def\chapoddpage{\chappager \ifodd\pageno \else \hbox to 0pt{} \chappager\fi} |
---|
4114 | |
---|
4115 | \def\setchapternewpage #1 {\csname CHAPPAG#1\endcsname} |
---|
4116 | |
---|
4117 | \def\CHAPPAGoff{% |
---|
4118 | \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager |
---|
4119 | \global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chapbreak |
---|
4120 | \global\let\pagealignmacro=\chappager} |
---|
4121 | |
---|
4122 | \def\CHAPPAGon{% |
---|
4123 | \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager |
---|
4124 | \global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chappager |
---|
4125 | \global\let\pagealignmacro=\chappager |
---|
4126 | \global\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSsingle}} |
---|
4127 | |
---|
4128 | \def\CHAPPAGodd{% |
---|
4129 | \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage |
---|
4130 | \global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chapoddpage |
---|
4131 | \global\let\pagealignmacro=\chapoddpage |
---|
4132 | \global\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSdouble}} |
---|
4133 | |
---|
4134 | \CHAPPAGon |
---|
4135 | |
---|
4136 | % Chapter opening. |
---|
4137 | % |
---|
4138 | % #1 is the text, #2 is the section type (Ynumbered, Ynothing, |
---|
4139 | % Yappendix, Yomitfromtoc), #3 the chapter number. |
---|
4140 | % |
---|
4141 | % To test against our argument. |
---|
4142 | \def\Ynothingkeyword{Ynothing} |
---|
4143 | \def\Yomitfromtockeyword{Yomitfromtoc} |
---|
4144 | \def\Yappendixkeyword{Yappendix} |
---|
4145 | % |
---|
4146 | \def\chapmacro#1#2#3{% |
---|
4147 | \pchapsepmacro |
---|
4148 | {% |
---|
4149 | \chapfonts \rm |
---|
4150 | % |
---|
4151 | % Have to define \thissection before calling \donoderef, because the |
---|
4152 | % xref code eventually uses it. On the other hand, it has to be called |
---|
4153 | % after \pchapsepmacro, or the headline will change too soon. |
---|
4154 | \gdef\thissection{#1}% |
---|
4155 | \gdef\thischaptername{#1}% |
---|
4156 | % |
---|
4157 | % Only insert the separating space if we have a chapter/appendix |
---|
4158 | % number, and don't print the unnumbered ``number''. |
---|
4159 | \def\temptype{#2}% |
---|
4160 | \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword |
---|
4161 | \setbox0 = \hbox{}% |
---|
4162 | \def\toctype{unnchap}% |
---|
4163 | \def\thischapter{#1}% |
---|
4164 | \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword |
---|
4165 | \setbox0 = \hbox{}% contents like unnumbered, but no toc entry |
---|
4166 | \def\toctype{omit}% |
---|
4167 | \xdef\thischapter{}% |
---|
4168 | \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword |
---|
4169 | \setbox0 = \hbox{\putwordAppendix{} #3\enspace}% |
---|
4170 | \def\toctype{app}% |
---|
4171 | % We don't substitute the actual chapter name into \thischapter |
---|
4172 | % because we don't want its macros evaluated now. And we don't |
---|
4173 | % use \thissection because that changes with each section. |
---|
4174 | % |
---|
4175 | \xdef\thischapter{\putwordAppendix{} \appendixletter: |
---|
4176 | \noexpand\thischaptername}% |
---|
4177 | \else |
---|
4178 | \setbox0 = \hbox{#3\enspace}% |
---|
4179 | \def\toctype{numchap}% |
---|
4180 | \xdef\thischapter{\putwordChapter{} \the\chapno: |
---|
4181 | \noexpand\thischaptername}% |
---|
4182 | \fi\fi\fi |
---|
4183 | % |
---|
4184 | % Write the toc entry for this chapter. Must come before the |
---|
4185 | % \donoderef, because we include the current node name in the toc |
---|
4186 | % entry, and \donoderef resets it to empty. |
---|
4187 | \writetocentry{\toctype}{#1}{#3}% |
---|
4188 | % |
---|
4189 | % For pdftex, we have to write out the node definition (aka, make |
---|
4190 | % the pdfdest) after any page break, but before the actual text has |
---|
4191 | % been typeset. If the destination for the pdf outline is after the |
---|
4192 | % text, then jumping from the outline may wind up with the text not |
---|
4193 | % being visible, for instance under high magnification. |
---|
4194 | \donoderef{#2}% |
---|
4195 | % |
---|
4196 | % Typeset the actual heading. |
---|
4197 | \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000 \tolerance=5000 \parindent=0pt \raggedright |
---|
4198 | \hangindent=\wd0 \centerparametersmaybe |
---|
4199 | \unhbox0 #1\par}% |
---|
4200 | }% |
---|
4201 | \nobreak\bigskip % no page break after a chapter title |
---|
4202 | \nobreak |
---|
4203 | } |
---|
4204 | |
---|
4205 | % @centerchap -- centered and unnumbered. |
---|
4206 | \let\centerparametersmaybe = \relax |
---|
4207 | \def\centerparameters{% |
---|
4208 | \advance\rightskip by 3\rightskip |
---|
4209 | \leftskip = \rightskip |
---|
4210 | \parfillskip = 0pt |
---|
4211 | } |
---|
4212 | |
---|
4213 | |
---|
4214 | % I don't think this chapter style is supported any more, so I'm not |
---|
4215 | % updating it with the new noderef stuff. We'll see. --karl, 11aug03. |
---|
4216 | % |
---|
4217 | \def\setchapterstyle #1 {\csname CHAPF#1\endcsname} |
---|
4218 | % |
---|
4219 | \def\unnchfopen #1{% |
---|
4220 | \chapoddpage {\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000 |
---|
4221 | \parindent=0pt\raggedright |
---|
4222 | \rm #1\hfill}}\bigskip \par\nobreak |
---|
4223 | } |
---|
4224 | \def\chfopen #1#2{\chapoddpage {\chapfonts |
---|
4225 | \vbox to 3in{\vfil \hbox to\hsize{\hfil #2} \hbox to\hsize{\hfil #1} \vfil}}% |
---|
4226 | \par\penalty 5000 % |
---|
4227 | } |
---|
4228 | \def\centerchfopen #1{% |
---|
4229 | \chapoddpage {\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000 |
---|
4230 | \parindent=0pt |
---|
4231 | \hfill {\rm #1}\hfill}}\bigskip \par\nobreak |
---|
4232 | } |
---|
4233 | \def\CHAPFopen{% |
---|
4234 | \global\let\chapmacro=\chfopen |
---|
4235 | \global\let\centerchapmacro=\centerchfopen} |
---|
4236 | |
---|
4237 | |
---|
4238 | % Section titles. These macros combine the section number parts and |
---|
4239 | % call the generic \sectionheading to do the printing. |
---|
4240 | % |
---|
4241 | \newskip\secheadingskip |
---|
4242 | \def\secheadingbreak{\dobreak \secheadingskip{-1000}} |
---|
4243 | |
---|
4244 | % Subsection titles. |
---|
4245 | \newskip\subsecheadingskip |
---|
4246 | \def\subsecheadingbreak{\dobreak \subsecheadingskip{-500}} |
---|
4247 | |
---|
4248 | % Subsubsection titles. |
---|
4249 | \def\subsubsecheadingskip{\subsecheadingskip} |
---|
4250 | \def\subsubsecheadingbreak{\subsecheadingbreak} |
---|
4251 | |
---|
4252 | |
---|
4253 | % Print any size, any type, section title. |
---|
4254 | % |
---|
4255 | % #1 is the text, #2 is the section level (sec/subsec/subsubsec), #3 is |
---|
4256 | % the section type for xrefs (Ynumbered, Ynothing, Yappendix), #4 is the |
---|
4257 | % section number. |
---|
4258 | % |
---|
4259 | \def\sectionheading#1#2#3#4{% |
---|
4260 | {% |
---|
4261 | % Switch to the right set of fonts. |
---|
4262 | \csname #2fonts\endcsname \rm |
---|
4263 | % |
---|
4264 | % Insert space above the heading. |
---|
4265 | \csname #2headingbreak\endcsname |
---|
4266 | % |
---|
4267 | % Only insert the space after the number if we have a section number. |
---|
4268 | \def\sectionlevel{#2}% |
---|
4269 | \def\temptype{#3}% |
---|
4270 | % |
---|
4271 | \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword |
---|
4272 | \setbox0 = \hbox{}% |
---|
4273 | \def\toctype{unn}% |
---|
4274 | \gdef\thissection{#1}% |
---|
4275 | \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword |
---|
4276 | % for @headings -- no section number, don't include in toc, |
---|
4277 | % and don't redefine \thissection. |
---|
4278 | \setbox0 = \hbox{}% |
---|
4279 | \def\toctype{omit}% |
---|
4280 | \let\sectionlevel=\empty |
---|
4281 | \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword |
---|
4282 | \setbox0 = \hbox{#4\enspace}% |
---|
4283 | \def\toctype{app}% |
---|
4284 | \gdef\thissection{#1}% |
---|
4285 | \else |
---|
4286 | \setbox0 = \hbox{#4\enspace}% |
---|
4287 | \def\toctype{num}% |
---|
4288 | \gdef\thissection{#1}% |
---|
4289 | \fi\fi\fi |
---|
4290 | % |
---|
4291 | % Write the toc entry (before \donoderef). See comments in \chfplain. |
---|
4292 | \writetocentry{\toctype\sectionlevel}{#1}{#4}% |
---|
4293 | % |
---|
4294 | % Write the node reference (= pdf destination for pdftex). |
---|
4295 | % Again, see comments in \chfplain. |
---|
4296 | \donoderef{#3}% |
---|
4297 | % |
---|
4298 | % Output the actual section heading. |
---|
4299 | \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000 \tolerance=5000 \parindent=0pt \raggedright |
---|
4300 | \hangindent=\wd0 % zero if no section number |
---|
4301 | \unhbox0 #1}% |
---|
4302 | }% |
---|
4303 | % Add extra space after the heading -- half of whatever came above it. |
---|
4304 | % Don't allow stretch, though. |
---|
4305 | \kern .5 \csname #2headingskip\endcsname |
---|
4306 | % |
---|
4307 | % Do not let the kern be a potential breakpoint, as it would be if it |
---|
4308 | % was followed by glue. |
---|
4309 | \nobreak |
---|
4310 | % |
---|
4311 | % We'll almost certainly start a paragraph next, so don't let that |
---|
4312 | % glue accumulate. (Not a breakpoint because it's preceded by a |
---|
4313 | % discardable item.) |
---|
4314 | \vskip-\parskip |
---|
4315 | % |
---|
4316 | % This \nobreak is purely so the last item on the list is a \penalty |
---|
4317 | % of 10000. This is so other code, for instance \parsebodycommon, can |
---|
4318 | % check for and avoid allowing breakpoints. Otherwise, it would |
---|
4319 | % insert a valid breakpoint between: |
---|
4320 | % @section sec-whatever |
---|
4321 | % @deffn def-whatever |
---|
4322 | \nobreak |
---|
4323 | } |
---|
4324 | |
---|
4325 | |
---|
4326 | \message{toc,} |
---|
4327 | % Table of contents. |
---|
4328 | \newwrite\tocfile |
---|
4329 | |
---|
4330 | % Write an entry to the toc file, opening it if necessary. |
---|
4331 | % Called from @chapter, etc. |
---|
4332 | % |
---|
4333 | % Example usage: \writetocentry{sec}{Section Name}{\the\chapno.\the\secno} |
---|
4334 | % We append the current node name (if any) and page number as additional |
---|
4335 | % arguments for the \{chap,sec,...}entry macros which will eventually |
---|
4336 | % read this. The node name is used in the pdf outlines as the |
---|
4337 | % destination to jump to. |
---|
4338 | % |
---|
4339 | % We open the .toc file for writing here instead of at @setfilename (or |
---|
4340 | % any other fixed time) so that @contents can be anywhere in the document. |
---|
4341 | % But if #1 is `omit', then we don't do anything. This is used for the |
---|
4342 | % table of contents chapter openings themselves. |
---|
4343 | % |
---|
4344 | \newif\iftocfileopened |
---|
4345 | \def\omitkeyword{omit}% |
---|
4346 | % |
---|
4347 | \def\writetocentry#1#2#3{% |
---|
4348 | \edef\writetoctype{#1}% |
---|
4349 | \ifx\writetoctype\omitkeyword \else |
---|
4350 | \iftocfileopened\else |
---|
4351 | \immediate\openout\tocfile = \jobname.toc |
---|
4352 | \global\tocfileopenedtrue |
---|
4353 | \fi |
---|
4354 | % |
---|
4355 | \iflinks |
---|
4356 | \toks0 = {#2}% |
---|
4357 | \toks2 = \expandafter{\lastnode}% |
---|
4358 | \edef\temp{\write\tocfile{\realbackslash #1entry{\the\toks0}{#3}% |
---|
4359 | {\the\toks2}{\noexpand\folio}}}% |
---|
4360 | \temp |
---|
4361 | \fi |
---|
4362 | \fi |
---|
4363 | % |
---|
4364 | % Tell \shipout to create a pdf destination on each page, if we're |
---|
4365 | % writing pdf. These are used in the table of contents. We can't |
---|
4366 | % just write one on every page because the title pages are numbered |
---|
4367 | % 1 and 2 (the page numbers aren't printed), and so are the first |
---|
4368 | % two pages of the document. Thus, we'd have two destinations named |
---|
4369 | % `1', and two named `2'. |
---|
4370 | \ifpdf \global\pdfmakepagedesttrue \fi |
---|
4371 | } |
---|
4372 | |
---|
4373 | \newskip\contentsrightmargin \contentsrightmargin=1in |
---|
4374 | \newcount\savepageno |
---|
4375 | \newcount\lastnegativepageno \lastnegativepageno = -1 |
---|
4376 | |
---|
4377 | % Prepare to read what we've written to \tocfile. |
---|
4378 | % |
---|
4379 | \def\startcontents#1{% |
---|
4380 | % If @setchapternewpage on, and @headings double, the contents should |
---|
4381 | % start on an odd page, unlike chapters. Thus, we maintain |
---|
4382 | % \contentsalignmacro in parallel with \pagealignmacro. |
---|
4383 | % From: Torbjorn Granlund <tege@matematik.su.se> |
---|
4384 | \contentsalignmacro |
---|
4385 | \immediate\closeout\tocfile |
---|
4386 | % |
---|
4387 | % Don't need to put `Contents' or `Short Contents' in the headline. |
---|
4388 | % It is abundantly clear what they are. |
---|
4389 | \def\thischapter{}% |
---|
4390 | \chapmacro{#1}{Yomitfromtoc}{}% |
---|
4391 | % |
---|
4392 | \savepageno = \pageno |
---|
4393 | \begingroup % Set up to handle contents files properly. |
---|
4394 | \catcode`\\=0 \catcode`\{=1 \catcode`\}=2 \catcode`\@=11 |
---|
4395 | % We can't do this, because then an actual ^ in a section |
---|
4396 | % title fails, e.g., @chapter ^ -- exponentiation. --karl, 9jul97. |
---|
4397 | %\catcode`\^=7 % to see ^^e4 as \"a etc. juha@piuha.ydi.vtt.fi |
---|
4398 | \raggedbottom % Worry more about breakpoints than the bottom. |
---|
4399 | \advance\hsize by -\contentsrightmargin % Don't use the full line length. |
---|
4400 | % |
---|
4401 | % Roman numerals for page numbers. |
---|
4402 | \ifnum \pageno>0 \global\pageno = \lastnegativepageno \fi |
---|
4403 | } |
---|
4404 | |
---|
4405 | |
---|
4406 | % Normal (long) toc. |
---|
4407 | \def\contents{% |
---|
4408 | \startcontents{\putwordTOC}% |
---|
4409 | \openin 1 \jobname.toc |
---|
4410 | \ifeof 1 \else |
---|
4411 | \input \jobname.toc |
---|
4412 | \fi |
---|
4413 | \vfill \eject |
---|
4414 | \contentsalignmacro % in case @setchapternewpage odd is in effect |
---|
4415 | \ifeof 1 \else |
---|
4416 | \pdfmakeoutlines |
---|
4417 | \fi |
---|
4418 | \closein 1 |
---|
4419 | \endgroup |
---|
4420 | \lastnegativepageno = \pageno |
---|
4421 | \global\pageno = \savepageno |
---|
4422 | } |
---|
4423 | |
---|
4424 | % And just the chapters. |
---|
4425 | \def\summarycontents{% |
---|
4426 | \startcontents{\putwordShortTOC}% |
---|
4427 | % |
---|
4428 | \let\numchapentry = \shortchapentry |
---|
4429 | \let\appentry = \shortchapentry |
---|
4430 | \let\unnchapentry = \shortunnchapentry |
---|
4431 | % We want a true roman here for the page numbers. |
---|
4432 | \secfonts |
---|
4433 | \let\rm=\shortcontrm \let\bf=\shortcontbf |
---|
4434 | \let\sl=\shortcontsl \let\tt=\shortconttt |
---|
4435 | \rm |
---|
4436 | \hyphenpenalty = 10000 |
---|
4437 | \advance\baselineskip by 1pt % Open it up a little. |
---|
4438 | \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{} |
---|
4439 | \let\appsecentry = \numsecentry |
---|
4440 | \let\unnsecentry = \numsecentry |
---|
4441 | \let\numsubsecentry = \numsecentry |
---|
4442 | \let\appsubsecentry = \numsecentry |
---|
4443 | \let\unnsubsecentry = \numsecentry |
---|
4444 | \let\numsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry |
---|
4445 | \let\appsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry |
---|
4446 | \let\unnsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry |
---|
4447 | \openin 1 \jobname.toc |
---|
4448 | \ifeof 1 \else |
---|
4449 | \input \jobname.toc |
---|
4450 | \fi |
---|
4451 | \closein 1 |
---|
4452 | \vfill \eject |
---|
4453 | \contentsalignmacro % in case @setchapternewpage odd is in effect |
---|
4454 | \endgroup |
---|
4455 | \lastnegativepageno = \pageno |
---|
4456 | \global\pageno = \savepageno |
---|
4457 | } |
---|
4458 | \let\shortcontents = \summarycontents |
---|
4459 | |
---|
4460 | % Typeset the label for a chapter or appendix for the short contents. |
---|
4461 | % The arg is, e.g., `A' for an appendix, or `3' for a chapter. |
---|
4462 | % |
---|
4463 | \def\shortchaplabel#1{% |
---|
4464 | % This space should be enough, since a single number is .5em, and the |
---|
4465 | % widest letter (M) is 1em, at least in the Computer Modern fonts. |
---|
4466 | % But use \hss just in case. |
---|
4467 | % (This space doesn't include the extra space that gets added after |
---|
4468 | % the label; that gets put in by \shortchapentry above.) |
---|
4469 | % |
---|
4470 | % We'd like to right-justify chapter numbers, but that looks strange |
---|
4471 | % with appendix letters. And right-justifying numbers and |
---|
4472 | % left-justifying letters looks strange when there is less than 10 |
---|
4473 | % chapters. Have to read the whole toc once to know how many chapters |
---|
4474 | % there are before deciding ... |
---|
4475 | \hbox to 1em{#1\hss}% |
---|
4476 | } |
---|
4477 | |
---|
4478 | % These macros generate individual entries in the table of contents. |
---|
4479 | % The first argument is the chapter or section name. |
---|
4480 | % The last argument is the page number. |
---|
4481 | % The arguments in between are the chapter number, section number, ... |
---|
4482 | |
---|
4483 | % Chapters, in the main contents. |
---|
4484 | \def\numchapentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}} |
---|
4485 | % |
---|
4486 | % Chapters, in the short toc. |
---|
4487 | % See comments in \dochapentry re vbox and related settings. |
---|
4488 | \def\shortchapentry#1#2#3#4{% |
---|
4489 | \tocentry{\shortchaplabel{#2}\labelspace #1}{\doshortpageno\bgroup#4\egroup}% |
---|
4490 | } |
---|
4491 | |
---|
4492 | % Appendices, in the main contents. |
---|
4493 | % Need the word Appendix, and a fixed-size box. |
---|
4494 | % |
---|
4495 | \def\appendixbox#1{% |
---|
4496 | % We use M since it's probably the widest letter. |
---|
4497 | \setbox0 = \hbox{\putwordAppendix{} M}% |
---|
4498 | \hbox to \wd0{\putwordAppendix{} #1\hss}} |
---|
4499 | % |
---|
4500 | \def\appentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{\appendixbox{#2}\labelspace#1}{#4}} |
---|
4501 | |
---|
4502 | % Unnumbered chapters. |
---|
4503 | \def\unnchapentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{#1}{#4}} |
---|
4504 | \def\shortunnchapentry#1#2#3#4{\tocentry{#1}{\doshortpageno\bgroup#4\egroup}} |
---|
4505 | |
---|
4506 | % Sections. |
---|
4507 | \def\numsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}} |
---|
4508 | \let\appsecentry=\numsecentry |
---|
4509 | \def\unnsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosecentry{#1}{#4}} |
---|
4510 | |
---|
4511 | % Subsections. |
---|
4512 | \def\numsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}} |
---|
4513 | \let\appsubsecentry=\numsubsecentry |
---|
4514 | \def\unnsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsecentry{#1}{#4}} |
---|
4515 | |
---|
4516 | % And subsubsections. |
---|
4517 | \def\numsubsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsubsecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}} |
---|
4518 | \let\appsubsubsecentry=\numsubsubsecentry |
---|
4519 | \def\unnsubsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsubsecentry{#1}{#4}} |
---|
4520 | |
---|
4521 | % This parameter controls the indentation of the various levels. |
---|
4522 | % Same as \defaultparindent. |
---|
4523 | \newdimen\tocindent \tocindent = 15pt |
---|
4524 | |
---|
4525 | % Now for the actual typesetting. In all these, #1 is the text and #2 is the |
---|
4526 | % page number. |
---|
4527 | % |
---|
4528 | % If the toc has to be broken over pages, we want it to be at chapters |
---|
4529 | % if at all possible; hence the \penalty. |
---|
4530 | \def\dochapentry#1#2{% |
---|
4531 | \penalty-300 \vskip1\baselineskip plus.33\baselineskip minus.25\baselineskip |
---|
4532 | \begingroup |
---|
4533 | \chapentryfonts |
---|
4534 | \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}% |
---|
4535 | \endgroup |
---|
4536 | \nobreak\vskip .25\baselineskip plus.1\baselineskip |
---|
4537 | } |
---|
4538 | |
---|
4539 | \def\dosecentry#1#2{\begingroup |
---|
4540 | \secentryfonts \leftskip=\tocindent |
---|
4541 | \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}% |
---|
4542 | \endgroup} |
---|
4543 | |
---|
4544 | \def\dosubsecentry#1#2{\begingroup |
---|
4545 | \subsecentryfonts \leftskip=2\tocindent |
---|
4546 | \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}% |
---|
4547 | \endgroup} |
---|
4548 | |
---|
4549 | \def\dosubsubsecentry#1#2{\begingroup |
---|
4550 | \subsubsecentryfonts \leftskip=3\tocindent |
---|
4551 | \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}% |
---|
4552 | \endgroup} |
---|
4553 | |
---|
4554 | % We use the same \entry macro as for the index entries. |
---|
4555 | \let\tocentry = \entry |
---|
4556 | |
---|
4557 | % Space between chapter (or whatever) number and the title. |
---|
4558 | \def\labelspace{\hskip1em \relax} |
---|
4559 | |
---|
4560 | \def\dopageno#1{{\rm #1}} |
---|
4561 | \def\doshortpageno#1{{\rm #1}} |
---|
4562 | |
---|
4563 | \def\chapentryfonts{\secfonts \rm} |
---|
4564 | \def\secentryfonts{\textfonts} |
---|
4565 | \def\subsecentryfonts{\textfonts} |
---|
4566 | \def\subsubsecentryfonts{\textfonts} |
---|
4567 | |
---|
4568 | |
---|
4569 | \message{environments,} |
---|
4570 | % @foo ... @end foo. |
---|
4571 | |
---|
4572 | % @point{}, @result{}, @expansion{}, @print{}, @equiv{}. |
---|
4573 | % |
---|
4574 | % Since these characters are used in examples, it should be an even number of |
---|
4575 | % \tt widths. Each \tt character is 1en, so two makes it 1em. |
---|
4576 | % |
---|
4577 | \def\point{$\star$} |
---|
4578 | \def\result{\leavevmode\raise.15ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\Rightarrow$\hfil}} |
---|
4579 | \def\expansion{\leavevmode\raise.1ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\mapsto$\hfil}} |
---|
4580 | \def\print{\leavevmode\lower.1ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\dashv$\hfil}} |
---|
4581 | \def\equiv{\leavevmode\lower.1ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\ptexequiv$\hfil}} |
---|
4582 | |
---|
4583 | % The @error{} command. |
---|
4584 | % Adapted from the TeXbook's \boxit. |
---|
4585 | % |
---|
4586 | \newbox\errorbox |
---|
4587 | % |
---|
4588 | {\tentt \global\dimen0 = 3em}% Width of the box. |
---|
4589 | \dimen2 = .55pt % Thickness of rules |
---|
4590 | % The text. (`r' is open on the right, `e' somewhat less so on the left.) |
---|
4591 | \setbox0 = \hbox{\kern-.75pt \tensf error\kern-1.5pt} |
---|
4592 | % |
---|
4593 | \setbox\errorbox=\hbox to \dimen0{\hfil |
---|
4594 | \hsize = \dimen0 \advance\hsize by -5.8pt % Space to left+right. |
---|
4595 | \advance\hsize by -2\dimen2 % Rules. |
---|
4596 | \vbox{% |
---|
4597 | \hrule height\dimen2 |
---|
4598 | \hbox{\vrule width\dimen2 \kern3pt % Space to left of text. |
---|
4599 | \vtop{\kern2.4pt \box0 \kern2.4pt}% Space above/below. |
---|
4600 | \kern3pt\vrule width\dimen2}% Space to right. |
---|
4601 | \hrule height\dimen2} |
---|
4602 | \hfil} |
---|
4603 | % |
---|
4604 | \def\error{\leavevmode\lower.7ex\copy\errorbox} |
---|
4605 | |
---|
4606 | % @tex ... @end tex escapes into raw Tex temporarily. |
---|
4607 | % One exception: @ is still an escape character, so that @end tex works. |
---|
4608 | % But \@ or @@ will get a plain tex @ character. |
---|
4609 | |
---|
4610 | \envdef\tex{% |
---|
4611 | \catcode `\\=0 \catcode `\{=1 \catcode `\}=2 |
---|
4612 | \catcode `\$=3 \catcode `\&=4 \catcode `\#=6 |
---|
4613 | \catcode `\^=7 \catcode `\_=8 \catcode `\~=\active \let~=\tie |
---|
4614 | \catcode `\%=14 |
---|
4615 | \catcode `\+=\other |
---|
4616 | \catcode `\"=\other |
---|
4617 | \catcode `\|=\other |
---|
4618 | \catcode `\<=\other |
---|
4619 | \catcode `\>=\other |
---|
4620 | \escapechar=`\\ |
---|
4621 | % |
---|
4622 | \let\b=\ptexb |
---|
4623 | \let\bullet=\ptexbullet |
---|
4624 | \let\c=\ptexc |
---|
4625 | \let\,=\ptexcomma |
---|
4626 | \let\.=\ptexdot |
---|
4627 | \let\dots=\ptexdots |
---|
4628 | \let\equiv=\ptexequiv |
---|
4629 | \let\!=\ptexexclam |
---|
4630 | \let\i=\ptexi |
---|
4631 | \let\indent=\ptexindent |
---|
4632 | \let\noindent=\ptexnoindent |
---|
4633 | \let\{=\ptexlbrace |
---|
4634 | \let\+=\tabalign |
---|
4635 | \let\}=\ptexrbrace |
---|
4636 | \let\/=\ptexslash |
---|
4637 | \let\*=\ptexstar |
---|
4638 | \let\t=\ptext |
---|
4639 | % |
---|
4640 | \def\endldots{\mathinner{\ldots\ldots\ldots\ldots}}% |
---|
4641 | \def\enddots{\relax\ifmmode\endldots\else$\mathsurround=0pt \endldots\,$\fi}% |
---|
4642 | \def\@{@}% |
---|
4643 | } |
---|
4644 | % There is no need to define \Etex. |
---|
4645 | |
---|
4646 | % Define @lisp ... @end lisp. |
---|
4647 | % @lisp environment forms a group so it can rebind things, |
---|
4648 | % including the definition of @end lisp (which normally is erroneous). |
---|
4649 | |
---|
4650 | % Amount to narrow the margins by for @lisp. |
---|
4651 | \newskip\lispnarrowing \lispnarrowing=0.4in |
---|
4652 | |
---|
4653 | % This is the definition that ^^M gets inside @lisp, @example, and other |
---|
4654 | % such environments. \null is better than a space, since it doesn't |
---|
4655 | % have any width. |
---|
4656 | \def\lisppar{\null\endgraf} |
---|
4657 | |
---|
4658 | % This space is always present above and below environments. |
---|
4659 | \newskip\envskipamount \envskipamount = 0pt |
---|
4660 | |
---|
4661 | % Make spacing and below environment symmetrical. We use \parskip here |
---|
4662 | % to help in doing that, since in @example-like environments \parskip |
---|
4663 | % is reset to zero; thus the \afterenvbreak inserts no space -- but the |
---|
4664 | % start of the next paragraph will insert \parskip. |
---|
4665 | % |
---|
4666 | \def\aboveenvbreak{{% |
---|
4667 | % =10000 instead of <10000 because of a special case in \itemzzz, q.v. |
---|
4668 | \ifnum \lastpenalty=10000 \else |
---|
4669 | \advance\envskipamount by \parskip |
---|
4670 | \endgraf |
---|
4671 | \ifdim\lastskip<\envskipamount |
---|
4672 | \removelastskip |
---|
4673 | % it's not a good place to break if the last penalty was \nobreak |
---|
4674 | % or better ... |
---|
4675 | \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000 \penalty-50 \fi |
---|
4676 | \vskip\envskipamount |
---|
4677 | \fi |
---|
4678 | \fi |
---|
4679 | }} |
---|
4680 | |
---|
4681 | \let\afterenvbreak = \aboveenvbreak |
---|
4682 | |
---|
4683 | % \nonarrowing is a flag. If "set", @lisp etc don't narrow margins. |
---|
4684 | \let\nonarrowing=\relax |
---|
4685 | |
---|
4686 | % @cartouche ... @end cartouche: draw rectangle w/rounded corners around |
---|
4687 | % environment contents. |
---|
4688 | \font\circle=lcircle10 |
---|
4689 | \newdimen\circthick |
---|
4690 | \newdimen\cartouter\newdimen\cartinner |
---|
4691 | \newskip\normbskip\newskip\normpskip\newskip\normlskip |
---|
4692 | \circthick=\fontdimen8\circle |
---|
4693 | % |
---|
4694 | \def\ctl{{\circle\char'013\hskip -6pt}}% 6pt from pl file: 1/2charwidth |
---|
4695 | \def\ctr{{\hskip 6pt\circle\char'010}} |
---|
4696 | \def\cbl{{\circle\char'012\hskip -6pt}} |
---|
4697 | \def\cbr{{\hskip 6pt\circle\char'011}} |
---|
4698 | \def\carttop{\hbox to \cartouter{\hskip\lskip |
---|
4699 | \ctl\leaders\hrule height\circthick\hfil\ctr |
---|
4700 | \hskip\rskip}} |
---|
4701 | \def\cartbot{\hbox to \cartouter{\hskip\lskip |
---|
4702 | \cbl\leaders\hrule height\circthick\hfil\cbr |
---|
4703 | \hskip\rskip}} |
---|
4704 | % |
---|
4705 | \newskip\lskip\newskip\rskip |
---|
4706 | |
---|
4707 | \envdef\cartouche{% |
---|
4708 | \ifhmode\par\fi % can't be in the midst of a paragraph. |
---|
4709 | \startsavinginserts |
---|
4710 | \lskip=\leftskip \rskip=\rightskip |
---|
4711 | \leftskip=0pt\rightskip=0pt % we want these *outside*. |
---|
4712 | \cartinner=\hsize \advance\cartinner by-\lskip |
---|
4713 | \advance\cartinner by-\rskip |
---|
4714 | \cartouter=\hsize |
---|
4715 | \advance\cartouter by 18.4pt % allow for 3pt kerns on either |
---|
4716 | % side, and for 6pt waste from |
---|
4717 | % each corner char, and rule thickness |
---|
4718 | \normbskip=\baselineskip \normpskip=\parskip \normlskip=\lineskip |
---|
4719 | % Flag to tell @lisp, etc., not to narrow margin. |
---|
4720 | \let\nonarrowing=\comment |
---|
4721 | \vbox\bgroup |
---|
4722 | \baselineskip=0pt\parskip=0pt\lineskip=0pt |
---|
4723 | \carttop |
---|
4724 | \hbox\bgroup |
---|
4725 | \hskip\lskip |
---|
4726 | \vrule\kern3pt |
---|
4727 | \vbox\bgroup |
---|
4728 | \kern3pt |
---|
4729 | \hsize=\cartinner |
---|
4730 | \baselineskip=\normbskip |
---|
4731 | \lineskip=\normlskip |
---|
4732 | \parskip=\normpskip |
---|
4733 | \vskip -\parskip |
---|
4734 | \comment % For explanation, see the end of \def\group. |
---|
4735 | } |
---|
4736 | \def\Ecartouche{% |
---|
4737 | \ifhmode\par\fi |
---|
4738 | \kern3pt |
---|
4739 | \egroup |
---|
4740 | \kern3pt\vrule |
---|
4741 | \hskip\rskip |
---|
4742 | \egroup |
---|
4743 | \cartbot |
---|
4744 | \egroup |
---|
4745 | \checkinserts |
---|
4746 | } |
---|
4747 | |
---|
4748 | |
---|
4749 | % This macro is called at the beginning of all the @example variants, |
---|
4750 | % inside a group. |
---|
4751 | \def\nonfillstart{% |
---|
4752 | \aboveenvbreak |
---|
4753 | \hfuzz = 12pt % Don't be fussy |
---|
4754 | \sepspaces % Make spaces be word-separators rather than space tokens. |
---|
4755 | \let\par = \lisppar % don't ignore blank lines |
---|
4756 | \obeylines % each line of input is a line of output |
---|
4757 | \parskip = 0pt |
---|
4758 | \parindent = 0pt |
---|
4759 | \emergencystretch = 0pt % don't try to avoid overfull boxes |
---|
4760 | % @cartouche defines \nonarrowing to inhibit narrowing |
---|
4761 | % at next level down. |
---|
4762 | \ifx\nonarrowing\relax |
---|
4763 | \advance \leftskip by \lispnarrowing |
---|
4764 | \exdentamount=\lispnarrowing |
---|
4765 | \fi |
---|
4766 | \let\exdent=\nofillexdent |
---|
4767 | } |
---|
4768 | |
---|
4769 | % If you want all examples etc. small: @set dispenvsize small. |
---|
4770 | % If you want even small examples the full size: @set dispenvsize nosmall. |
---|
4771 | % This affects the following displayed environments: |
---|
4772 | % @example, @display, @format, @lisp |
---|
4773 | % |
---|
4774 | \def\smallword{small} |
---|
4775 | \def\nosmallword{nosmall} |
---|
4776 | \let\SETdispenvsize\relax |
---|
4777 | \def\setnormaldispenv{% |
---|
4778 | \ifx\SETdispenvsize\smallword |
---|
4779 | \smallexamplefonts \rm |
---|
4780 | \fi |
---|
4781 | } |
---|
4782 | \def\setsmalldispenv{% |
---|
4783 | \ifx\SETdispenvsize\nosmallword |
---|
4784 | \else |
---|
4785 | \smallexamplefonts \rm |
---|
4786 | \fi |
---|
4787 | } |
---|
4788 | |
---|
4789 | % We often define two environments, @foo and @smallfoo. |
---|
4790 | % Let's do it by one command: |
---|
4791 | \def\makedispenv #1#2{ |
---|
4792 | \expandafter\envdef\csname#1\endcsname {\setnormaldispenv #2} |
---|
4793 | \expandafter\envdef\csname small#1\endcsname {\setsmalldispenv #2} |
---|
4794 | \expandafter\let\csname E#1\endcsname \afterenvbreak |
---|
4795 | \expandafter\let\csname Esmall#1\endcsname \afterenvbreak |
---|
4796 | } |
---|
4797 | |
---|
4798 | % Define two synonyms: |
---|
4799 | \def\maketwodispenvs #1#2#3{ |
---|
4800 | \makedispenv{#1}{#3} |
---|
4801 | \makedispenv{#2}{#3} |
---|
4802 | } |
---|
4803 | |
---|
4804 | % @lisp: indented, narrowed, typewriter font; @example: same as @lisp. |
---|
4805 | % |
---|
4806 | % @smallexample and @smalllisp: use smaller fonts. |
---|
4807 | % Originally contributed by Pavel@xerox. |
---|
4808 | % |
---|
4809 | \maketwodispenvs {lisp}{example}{% |
---|
4810 | \nonfillstart |
---|
4811 | \tt |
---|
4812 | \let\kbdfont = \kbdexamplefont % Allow @kbd to do something special. |
---|
4813 | \gobble % eat return |
---|
4814 | } |
---|
4815 | |
---|
4816 | % @display/@smalldisplay: same as @lisp except keep current font. |
---|
4817 | % |
---|
4818 | \makedispenv {display}{% |
---|
4819 | \nonfillstart |
---|
4820 | \gobble |
---|
4821 | } |
---|
4822 | |
---|
4823 | % @format/@smallformat: same as @display except don't narrow margins. |
---|
4824 | % |
---|
4825 | \makedispenv{format}{% |
---|
4826 | \let\nonarrowing = t% |
---|
4827 | \nonfillstart |
---|
4828 | \gobble |
---|
4829 | } |
---|
4830 | |
---|
4831 | % @flushleft: same as @format, but doesn't obey \SETdispenvsize. |
---|
4832 | \envdef\flushleft{% |
---|
4833 | \let\nonarrowing = t% |
---|
4834 | \nonfillstart |
---|
4835 | \gobble |
---|
4836 | } |
---|
4837 | \let\Eflushleft = \afterenvbreak |
---|
4838 | |
---|
4839 | % @flushright. |
---|
4840 | % |
---|
4841 | \envdef\flushright{% |
---|
4842 | \let\nonarrowing = t% |
---|
4843 | \nonfillstart |
---|
4844 | \advance\leftskip by 0pt plus 1fill |
---|
4845 | \gobble |
---|
4846 | } |
---|
4847 | \let\Eflushright = \afterenvbreak |
---|
4848 | |
---|
4849 | |
---|
4850 | % @quotation does normal linebreaking (hence we can't use \nonfillstart) |
---|
4851 | % and narrows the margins. We keep \parskip nonzero in general, since |
---|
4852 | % we're doing normal filling. So, when using \aboveenvbreak and |
---|
4853 | % \afterenvbreak, temporarily make \parskip 0. |
---|
4854 | % |
---|
4855 | \envdef\quotation{% |
---|
4856 | {\parskip=0pt \aboveenvbreak}% because \aboveenvbreak inserts \parskip |
---|
4857 | \parindent=0pt |
---|
4858 | % |
---|
4859 | % @cartouche defines \nonarrowing to inhibit narrowing at next level down. |
---|
4860 | \ifx\nonarrowing\relax |
---|
4861 | \advance\leftskip by \lispnarrowing |
---|
4862 | \advance\rightskip by \lispnarrowing |
---|
4863 | \exdentamount = \lispnarrowing |
---|
4864 | \let\nonarrowing = \relax |
---|
4865 | \fi |
---|
4866 | \parsearg\quotationlabel |
---|
4867 | } |
---|
4868 | |
---|
4869 | % We have retained a nonzero parskip for the environment, since we're |
---|
4870 | % doing normal filling. |
---|
4871 | % |
---|
4872 | \def\Equotation{% |
---|
4873 | \par |
---|
4874 | \ifx\quotationauthor\undefined\else |
---|
4875 | % indent a bit. |
---|
4876 | \leftline{\kern 2\leftskip \sl ---\quotationauthor}% |
---|
4877 | \fi |
---|
4878 | {\parskip=0pt \afterenvbreak}% |
---|
4879 | } |
---|
4880 | |
---|
4881 | % If we're given an argument, typeset it in bold with a colon after. |
---|
4882 | \def\quotationlabel#1{% |
---|
4883 | \def\temp{#1}% |
---|
4884 | \ifx\temp\empty \else |
---|
4885 | {\bf #1: }% |
---|
4886 | \fi |
---|
4887 | } |
---|
4888 | |
---|
4889 | |
---|
4890 | % LaTeX-like @verbatim...@end verbatim and @verb{<char>...<char>} |
---|
4891 | % If we want to allow any <char> as delimiter, |
---|
4892 | % we need the curly braces so that makeinfo sees the @verb command, eg: |
---|
4893 | % `@verbx...x' would look like the '@verbx' command. --janneke@gnu.org |
---|
4894 | % |
---|
4895 | % [Knuth]: Donald Ervin Knuth, 1996. The TeXbook. |
---|
4896 | % |
---|
4897 | % [Knuth] p.344; only we need to do the other characters Texinfo sets |
---|
4898 | % active too. Otherwise, they get lost as the first character on a |
---|
4899 | % verbatim line. |
---|
4900 | \def\dospecials{% |
---|
4901 | \do\ \do\\\do\{\do\}\do\$\do\&% |
---|
4902 | \do\#\do\^\do\^^K\do\_\do\^^A\do\%\do\~% |
---|
4903 | \do\<\do\>\do\|\do\@\do+\do\"% |
---|
4904 | } |
---|
4905 | % |
---|
4906 | % [Knuth] p. 380 |
---|
4907 | \def\uncatcodespecials{% |
---|
4908 | \def\do##1{\catcode`##1=\other}\dospecials} |
---|
4909 | % |
---|
4910 | % [Knuth] pp. 380,381,391 |
---|
4911 | % Disable Spanish ligatures ?` and !` of \tt font |
---|
4912 | \begingroup |
---|
4913 | \catcode`\`=\active\gdef`{\relax\lq} |
---|
4914 | \endgroup |
---|
4915 | % |
---|
4916 | % Setup for the @verb command. |
---|
4917 | % |
---|
4918 | % Eight spaces for a tab |
---|
4919 | \begingroup |
---|
4920 | \catcode`\^^I=\active |
---|
4921 | \gdef\tabeightspaces{\catcode`\^^I=\active\def^^I{\ \ \ \ \ \ \ \ }} |
---|
4922 | \endgroup |
---|
4923 | % |
---|
4924 | \def\setupverb{% |
---|
4925 | \tt % easiest (and conventionally used) font for verbatim |
---|
4926 | \def\par{\leavevmode\endgraf}% |
---|
4927 | \catcode`\`=\active |
---|
4928 | \tabeightspaces |
---|
4929 | % Respect line breaks, |
---|
4930 | % print special symbols as themselves, and |
---|
4931 | % make each space count |
---|
4932 | % must do in this order: |
---|
4933 | \obeylines \uncatcodespecials \sepspaces |
---|
4934 | } |
---|
4935 | |
---|
4936 | % Setup for the @verbatim environment |
---|
4937 | % |
---|
4938 | % Real tab expansion |
---|
4939 | \newdimen\tabw \setbox0=\hbox{\tt\space} \tabw=8\wd0 % tab amount |
---|
4940 | % |
---|
4941 | \def\starttabbox{\setbox0=\hbox\bgroup} |
---|
4942 | \begingroup |
---|
4943 | \catcode`\^^I=\active |
---|
4944 | \gdef\tabexpand{% |
---|
4945 | \catcode`\^^I=\active |
---|
4946 | \def^^I{\leavevmode\egroup |
---|
4947 | \dimen0=\wd0 % the width so far, or since the previous tab |
---|
4948 | \divide\dimen0 by\tabw |
---|
4949 | \multiply\dimen0 by\tabw % compute previous multiple of \tabw |
---|
4950 | \advance\dimen0 by\tabw % advance to next multiple of \tabw |
---|
4951 | \wd0=\dimen0 \box0 \starttabbox |
---|
4952 | }% |
---|
4953 | } |
---|
4954 | \endgroup |
---|
4955 | \def\setupverbatim{% |
---|
4956 | \nonfillstart |
---|
4957 | \advance\leftskip by -\defbodyindent |
---|
4958 | % Easiest (and conventionally used) font for verbatim |
---|
4959 | \tt |
---|
4960 | \def\par{\leavevmode\egroup\box0\endgraf}% |
---|
4961 | \catcode`\`=\active |
---|
4962 | \tabexpand |
---|
4963 | % Respect line breaks, |
---|
4964 | % print special symbols as themselves, and |
---|
4965 | % make each space count |
---|
4966 | % must do in this order: |
---|
4967 | \obeylines \uncatcodespecials \sepspaces |
---|
4968 | \everypar{\starttabbox}% |
---|
4969 | } |
---|
4970 | |
---|
4971 | % Do the @verb magic: verbatim text is quoted by unique |
---|
4972 | % delimiter characters. Before first delimiter expect a |
---|
4973 | % right brace, after last delimiter expect closing brace: |
---|
4974 | % |
---|
4975 | % \def\doverb'{'<char>#1<char>'}'{#1} |
---|
4976 | % |
---|
4977 | % [Knuth] p. 382; only eat outer {} |
---|
4978 | \begingroup |
---|
4979 | \catcode`[=1\catcode`]=2\catcode`\{=\other\catcode`\}=\other |
---|
4980 | \gdef\doverb{#1[\def\next##1#1}[##1\endgroup]\next] |
---|
4981 | \endgroup |
---|
4982 | % |
---|
4983 | \def\verb{\begingroup\setupverb\doverb} |
---|
4984 | % |
---|
4985 | % |
---|
4986 | % Do the @verbatim magic: define the macro \doverbatim so that |
---|
4987 | % the (first) argument ends when '@end verbatim' is reached, ie: |
---|
4988 | % |
---|
4989 | % \def\doverbatim#1@end verbatim{#1} |
---|
4990 | % |
---|
4991 | % For Texinfo it's a lot easier than for LaTeX, |
---|
4992 | % because texinfo's \verbatim doesn't stop at '\end{verbatim}': |
---|
4993 | % we need not redefine '\', '{' and '}'. |
---|
4994 | % |
---|
4995 | % Inspired by LaTeX's verbatim command set [latex.ltx] |
---|
4996 | % |
---|
4997 | \begingroup |
---|
4998 | \catcode`\ =\active |
---|
4999 | \obeylines % |
---|
5000 | % ignore everything up to the first ^^M, that's the newline at the end |
---|
5001 | % of the @verbatim input line itself. Otherwise we get an extra blank |
---|
5002 | % line in the output. |
---|
5003 | \xdef\doverbatim#1^^M#2@end verbatim{#2\noexpand\end\gobble verbatim}% |
---|
5004 | % We really want {...\end verbatim} in the body of the macro, but |
---|
5005 | % without the active space; thus we have to use \xdef and \gobble. |
---|
5006 | \endgroup |
---|
5007 | % |
---|
5008 | \envdef\verbatim{% |
---|
5009 | \setupverbatim\doverbatim |
---|
5010 | } |
---|
5011 | \let\Everbatim = \afterenvbreak |
---|
5012 | |
---|
5013 | |
---|
5014 | % @verbatiminclude FILE - insert text of file in verbatim environment. |
---|
5015 | % |
---|
5016 | \def\verbatiminclude{\parseargusing\filenamecatcodes\doverbatiminclude} |
---|
5017 | % |
---|
5018 | \def\doverbatiminclude#1{% |
---|
5019 | {% |
---|
5020 | \makevalueexpandable |
---|
5021 | \setupverbatim |
---|
5022 | \input #1 |
---|
5023 | \afterenvbreak |
---|
5024 | }% |
---|
5025 | } |
---|
5026 | |
---|
5027 | % @copying ... @end copying. |
---|
5028 | % Save the text away for @insertcopying later. Many commands won't be |
---|
5029 | % allowed in this context, but that's ok. |
---|
5030 | % |
---|
5031 | % We save the uninterpreted tokens, rather than creating a box. |
---|
5032 | % Saving the text in a box would be much easier, but then all the |
---|
5033 | % typesetting commands (@smallbook, font changes, etc.) have to be done |
---|
5034 | % beforehand -- and a) we want @copying to be done first in the source |
---|
5035 | % file; b) letting users define the frontmatter in as flexible order as |
---|
5036 | % possible is very desirable. |
---|
5037 | % |
---|
5038 | \def\copying{\begingroup |
---|
5039 | % Define a command to swallow text until we reach `@end copying'. |
---|
5040 | % \ is the escape char in this texinfo.tex file, so it is the |
---|
5041 | % delimiter for the command; @ will be the escape char when we read |
---|
5042 | % it, but that doesn't matter. |
---|
5043 | \long\def\docopying##1\end copying{\gdef\copyingtext{##1}\enddocopying}% |
---|
5044 | % |
---|
5045 | % We must preserve ^^M's in the input file; see \insertcopying below. |
---|
5046 | \catcode`\^^M = \active |
---|
5047 | \docopying |
---|
5048 | } |
---|
5049 | |
---|
5050 | % What we do to finish off the copying text. |
---|
5051 | % |
---|
5052 | \def\enddocopying{\endgroup\ignorespaces} |
---|
5053 | |
---|
5054 | % @insertcopying. Here we must play games with ^^M's. On the one hand, |
---|
5055 | % we need them to delimit commands such as `@end quotation', so they |
---|
5056 | % must be active. On the other hand, we certainly don't want every |
---|
5057 | % end-of-line to be a \par, as would happen with the normal active |
---|
5058 | % definition of ^^M. On the third hand, two ^^M's in a row should still |
---|
5059 | % generate a \par. |
---|
5060 | % |
---|
5061 | % Our approach is to make ^^M insert a space and a penalty1 normally; |
---|
5062 | % then it can also check if \lastpenalty=1. If it does, then manually |
---|
5063 | % do \par. |
---|
5064 | % |
---|
5065 | % This messes up the normal definitions of @c[omment], so we redefine |
---|
5066 | % it. Similarly for @ignore. (These commands are used in the gcc |
---|
5067 | % manual for man page generation.) |
---|
5068 | % |
---|
5069 | % Seems pretty fragile, most line-oriented commands will presumably |
---|
5070 | % fail, but for the limited use of getting the copying text (which |
---|
5071 | % should be quite simple) inserted, we can hope it's ok. |
---|
5072 | % |
---|
5073 | {\catcode`\^^M=\active % |
---|
5074 | \gdef\insertcopying{\begingroup % |
---|
5075 | \parindent = 0pt % looks wrong on title page |
---|
5076 | \def^^M{% |
---|
5077 | \ifnum \lastpenalty=1 % |
---|
5078 | \par % |
---|
5079 | \else % |
---|
5080 | \space \penalty 1 % |
---|
5081 | \fi % |
---|
5082 | }% |
---|
5083 | % |
---|
5084 | % Fix @c[omment] for catcode 13 ^^M's. |
---|
5085 | \def\c##1^^M{\ignorespaces}% |
---|
5086 | \let\comment = \c % |
---|
5087 | % |
---|
5088 | % Don't bother jumping through all the hoops that \doignore does, it |
---|
5089 | % would be very hard since the catcodes are already set. |
---|
5090 | \long\def\ignore##1\end ignore{\ignorespaces}% |
---|
5091 | % |
---|
5092 | \copyingtext % |
---|
5093 | \endgroup}% |
---|
5094 | } |
---|
5095 | |
---|
5096 | \message{defuns,} |
---|
5097 | % @defun etc. |
---|
5098 | |
---|
5099 | \newskip\defbodyindent \defbodyindent=.4in |
---|
5100 | \newskip\defargsindent \defargsindent=50pt |
---|
5101 | \newskip\deflastargmargin \deflastargmargin=18pt |
---|
5102 | |
---|
5103 | % Start the processing of @deffn: |
---|
5104 | \def\startdefun{% |
---|
5105 | \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000 |
---|
5106 | \medbreak |
---|
5107 | \else |
---|
5108 | % If there are two @def commands in a row, we'll have a \nobreak, |
---|
5109 | % which is there to keep the function description together with its |
---|
5110 | % header. But if there's nothing but headers, we need to allow a |
---|
5111 | % break somewhere. Check for penalty 10002 (inserted by |
---|
5112 | % \defargscommonending) instead of 10000, since the sectioning |
---|
5113 | % commands insert a \penalty10000, and we don't want to allow a break |
---|
5114 | % between a section heading and a defun. |
---|
5115 | \ifnum\lastpenalty=10002 \penalty2000 \fi |
---|
5116 | % |
---|
5117 | % Similarly, after a section heading, do not allow a break. |
---|
5118 | % But do insert the glue. |
---|
5119 | \medskip % preceded by discardable penalty, so not a breakpoint |
---|
5120 | \fi |
---|
5121 | % |
---|
5122 | \parindent=0in |
---|
5123 | \advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent |
---|
5124 | \exdentamount=\defbodyindent |
---|
5125 | } |
---|
5126 | |
---|
5127 | \def\dodefunx#1{% |
---|
5128 | % First, check whether we are in the right environment: |
---|
5129 | \checkenv#1% |
---|
5130 | % |
---|
5131 | % As above, allow line break if we have multiple x headers in a row. |
---|
5132 | % It's not a great place, though. |
---|
5133 | \ifnum\lastpenalty=10002 \penalty3000 \fi |
---|
5134 | % |
---|
5135 | % And now, it's time to reuse the body of the original defun: |
---|
5136 | \expandafter\gobbledefun#1% |
---|
5137 | } |
---|
5138 | \def\gobbledefun#1\startdefun{} |
---|
5139 | |
---|
5140 | % \printdefunline \deffnheader{text} |
---|
5141 | % |
---|
5142 | \def\printdefunline#1#2{% |
---|
5143 | \begingroup |
---|
5144 | % call \deffnheader: |
---|
5145 | #1#2 \endheader |
---|
5146 | % common ending: |
---|
5147 | \interlinepenalty = 10000 |
---|
5148 | \advance\rightskip by 0pt plus 1fil |
---|
5149 | \endgraf |
---|
5150 | \nobreak\vskip -\parskip |
---|
5151 | \penalty 10002 % signal to \startdefun and \dodefunx |
---|
5152 | % Some of the @defun-type tags do not enable magic parentheses, |
---|
5153 | % rendering the following check redundant. But we don't optimize. |
---|
5154 | \checkparencounts |
---|
5155 | \endgroup |
---|
5156 | } |
---|
5157 | |
---|
5158 | \def\Edefun{\endgraf\medbreak} |
---|
5159 | |
---|
5160 | % \makedefun{deffn} creates \deffn, \deffnx and \Edeffn; |
---|
5161 | % the only thing remainnig is to define \deffnheader. |
---|
5162 | % |
---|
5163 | \def\makedefun#1{% |
---|
5164 | \expandafter\let\csname E#1\endcsname = \Edefun |
---|
5165 | \edef\temp{\noexpand\domakedefun |
---|
5166 | \makecsname{#1}\makecsname{#1x}\makecsname{#1header}}% |
---|
5167 | \temp |
---|
5168 | } |
---|
5169 | |
---|
5170 | % \domakedefun \deffn \deffnx \deffnheader |
---|
5171 | % |
---|
5172 | % Define \deffn and \deffnx, without parameters. |
---|
5173 | % \deffnheader has to be defined explicitly. |
---|
5174 | % |
---|
5175 | \def\domakedefun#1#2#3{% |
---|
5176 | \envdef#1{% |
---|
5177 | \startdefun |
---|
5178 | \parseargusing\activeparens{\printdefunline#3}% |
---|
5179 | }% |
---|
5180 | \def#2{\dodefunx#1}% |
---|
5181 | \def#3% |
---|
5182 | } |
---|
5183 | |
---|
5184 | %%% Untyped functions: |
---|
5185 | |
---|
5186 | % @deffn category name args |
---|
5187 | \makedefun{deffn}{\deffngeneral{}} |
---|
5188 | |
---|
5189 | % @deffn category class name args |
---|
5190 | \makedefun{defop}#1 {\defopon{#1\ \putwordon}} |
---|
5191 | |
---|
5192 | % \defopon {category on}class name args |
---|
5193 | \def\defopon#1#2 {\deffngeneral{\putwordon\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} } |
---|
5194 | |
---|
5195 | % \deffngeneral {subind}category name args |
---|
5196 | % |
---|
5197 | \def\deffngeneral#1#2 #3 #4\endheader{% |
---|
5198 | % Remember that \dosubind{fn}{foo}{} is equivalent to \doind{fn}{foo}. |
---|
5199 | \dosubind{fn}{\code{#3}}{#1}% |
---|
5200 | \defname{#2}{}{#3}\magicamp\defunargs{#4\unskip}% |
---|
5201 | } |
---|
5202 | |
---|
5203 | %%% Typed functions: |
---|
5204 | |
---|
5205 | % @deftypefn category type name args |
---|
5206 | \makedefun{deftypefn}{\deftypefngeneral{}} |
---|
5207 | |
---|
5208 | % @deftypeop category class type name args |
---|
5209 | \makedefun{deftypeop}#1 {\deftypeopon{#1\ \putwordon}} |
---|
5210 | |
---|
5211 | % \deftypeopon {category on}class type name args |
---|
5212 | \def\deftypeopon#1#2 {\deftypefngeneral{\putwordon\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} } |
---|
5213 | |
---|
5214 | % \deftypefngeneral {subind}category type name args |
---|
5215 | % |
---|
5216 | \def\deftypefngeneral#1#2 #3 #4 #5\endheader{% |
---|
5217 | \dosubind{fn}{\code{#4}}{#1}% |
---|
5218 | \defname{#2}{#3}{#4}\defunargs{#5\unskip}% |
---|
5219 | } |
---|
5220 | |
---|
5221 | %%% Typed variables: |
---|
5222 | |
---|
5223 | % @deftypevr category type var args |
---|
5224 | \makedefun{deftypevr}{\deftypecvgeneral{}} |
---|
5225 | |
---|
5226 | % @deftypecv category class type var args |
---|
5227 | \makedefun{deftypecv}#1 {\deftypecvof{#1\ \putwordof}} |
---|
5228 | |
---|
5229 | % \deftypecvof {category of}class type var args |
---|
5230 | \def\deftypecvof#1#2 {\deftypecvgeneral{\putwordof\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} } |
---|
5231 | |
---|
5232 | % \deftypecvgeneral {subind}category type var args |
---|
5233 | % |
---|
5234 | \def\deftypecvgeneral#1#2 #3 #4 #5\endheader{% |
---|
5235 | \dosubind{vr}{\code{#4}}{#1}% |
---|
5236 | \defname{#2}{#3}{#4}\defunargs{#5\unskip}% |
---|
5237 | } |
---|
5238 | |
---|
5239 | %%% Untyped variables: |
---|
5240 | |
---|
5241 | % @defvr category var args |
---|
5242 | \makedefun{defvr}#1 {\deftypevrheader{#1} {} } |
---|
5243 | |
---|
5244 | % @defcv category class var args |
---|
5245 | \makedefun{defcv}#1 {\defcvof{#1\ \putwordof}} |
---|
5246 | |
---|
5247 | % \defcvof {category of}class var args |
---|
5248 | \def\defcvof#1#2 {\deftypecvof{#1}#2 {} } |
---|
5249 | |
---|
5250 | %%% Type: |
---|
5251 | % @deftp category name args |
---|
5252 | \makedefun{deftp}#1 #2 #3\endheader{% |
---|
5253 | \doind{tp}{\code{#2}}% |
---|
5254 | \defname{#1}{}{#2}\defunargs{#3\unskip}% |
---|
5255 | } |
---|
5256 | |
---|
5257 | % Remaining @defun-like shortcuts: |
---|
5258 | \makedefun{defun}{\deffnheader{\putwordDeffunc} } |
---|
5259 | \makedefun{defmac}{\deffnheader{\putwordDefmac} } |
---|
5260 | \makedefun{defspec}{\deffnheader{\putwordDefspec} } |
---|
5261 | \makedefun{deftypefun}{\deftypefnheader{\putwordDeffunc} } |
---|
5262 | \makedefun{defvar}{\defvrheader{\putwordDefvar} } |
---|
5263 | \makedefun{defopt}{\defvrheader{\putwordDefopt} } |
---|
5264 | \makedefun{deftypevar}{\deftypevrheader{\putwordDefvar} } |
---|
5265 | \makedefun{defmethod}{\defopon\putwordMethodon} |
---|
5266 | \makedefun{deftypemethod}{\deftypeopon\putwordMethodon} |
---|
5267 | \makedefun{defivar}{\defcvof\putwordInstanceVariableof} |
---|
5268 | \makedefun{deftypeivar}{\deftypecvof\putwordInstanceVariableof} |
---|
5269 | |
---|
5270 | % \defname, which formats the name of the @def (not the args). |
---|
5271 | % #1 is the category, such as "Function". |
---|
5272 | % #2 is the return type, if any. |
---|
5273 | % #3 is the function name. |
---|
5274 | % |
---|
5275 | % We are followed by (but not passed) the arguments, if any. |
---|
5276 | % |
---|
5277 | \def\defname#1#2#3{% |
---|
5278 | % Get the values of \leftskip and \rightskip as they were outside the @def... |
---|
5279 | \advance\leftskip by -\defbodyindent |
---|
5280 | % |
---|
5281 | % How we'll format the type name. Putting it in brackets helps |
---|
5282 | % distinguish it from the body text that may end up on the next line |
---|
5283 | % just below it. |
---|
5284 | \def\temp{#1}% |
---|
5285 | \setbox0=\hbox{\kern\deflastargmargin \ifx\temp\empty\else [\rm\temp]\fi} |
---|
5286 | % |
---|
5287 | % Figure out line sizes for the paragraph shape. |
---|
5288 | % The first line needs space for \box0; but if \rightskip is nonzero, |
---|
5289 | % we need only space for the part of \box0 which exceeds it: |
---|
5290 | \dimen0=\hsize \advance\dimen0 by -\wd0 \advance\dimen0 by \rightskip |
---|
5291 | % The continuations: |
---|
5292 | \dimen2=\hsize \advance\dimen2 by -\defargsindent |
---|
5293 | % (plain.tex says that \dimen1 should be used only as global.) |
---|
5294 | \parshape 2 0in \dimen0 \defargsindent \dimen2 |
---|
5295 | % |
---|
5296 | % Put the type name to the right margin. |
---|
5297 | \noindent |
---|
5298 | \hbox to 0pt{% |
---|
5299 | \hfil\box0 \kern-\hsize |
---|
5300 | % \hsize has to be shortened this way: |
---|
5301 | \kern\leftskip |
---|
5302 | % Intentionally do not respect \rightskip, since we need the space. |
---|
5303 | }% |
---|
5304 | % |
---|
5305 | % Allow all lines to be underfull without complaint: |
---|
5306 | \tolerance=10000 \hbadness=10000 |
---|
5307 | \exdentamount=\defbodyindent |
---|
5308 | {% |
---|
5309 | % defun fonts. We use typewriter by default (used to be bold) because: |
---|
5310 | % . we're printing identifiers, they should be in tt in principle. |
---|
5311 | % . in languages with many accents, such as Czech or French, it's |
---|
5312 | % common to leave accents off identifiers. The result looks ok in |
---|
5313 | % tt, but exceedingly strange in rm. |
---|
5314 | % . we don't want -- and --- to be treated as ligatures. |
---|
5315 | % . this still does not fix the ?` and !` ligatures, but so far no |
---|
5316 | % one has made identifiers using them :). |
---|
5317 | \df \tt |
---|
5318 | \def\temp{#2}% return value type |
---|
5319 | \ifx\temp\empty\else \tclose{\temp} \fi |
---|
5320 | #3% output function name |
---|
5321 | }% |
---|
5322 | {\rm\enskip}% hskip 0.5 em of \tenrm |
---|
5323 | % |
---|
5324 | \boldbrax |
---|
5325 | % arguments will be output next, if any. |
---|
5326 | } |
---|
5327 | |
---|
5328 | % Print arguments in slanted roman (not ttsl), inconsistently with using |
---|
5329 | % tt for the name. This is because literal text is sometimes needed in |
---|
5330 | % the argument list (groff manual), and ttsl and tt are not very |
---|
5331 | % distinguishable. Prevent hyphenation at `-' chars. |
---|
5332 | % |
---|
5333 | \def\defunargs#1{% |
---|
5334 | % use sl by default (not ttsl), |
---|
5335 | % tt for the names. |
---|
5336 | \df \sl \hyphenchar\font=0 |
---|
5337 | % |
---|
5338 | % On the other hand, if an argument has two dashes (for instance), we |
---|
5339 | % want a way to get ttsl. Let's try @var for that. |
---|
5340 | \let\var=\ttslanted |
---|
5341 | #1% |
---|
5342 | \sl\hyphenchar\font=45 |
---|
5343 | } |
---|
5344 | |
---|
5345 | % We want ()&[] to print specially on the defun line. |
---|
5346 | % |
---|
5347 | \def\activeparens{% |
---|
5348 | \catcode`\(=\active \catcode`\)=\active |
---|
5349 | \catcode`\[=\active \catcode`\]=\active |
---|
5350 | \catcode`\&=\active |
---|
5351 | } |
---|
5352 | |
---|
5353 | % Make control sequences which act like normal parenthesis chars. |
---|
5354 | \let\lparen = ( \let\rparen = ) |
---|
5355 | |
---|
5356 | % Be sure that we always have a definition for `(', etc. For example, |
---|
5357 | % if the fn name has parens in it, \boldbrax will not be in effect yet, |
---|
5358 | % so TeX would otherwise complain about undefined control sequence. |
---|
5359 | { |
---|
5360 | \activeparens |
---|
5361 | \global\let(=\lparen \global\let)=\rparen |
---|
5362 | \global\let[=\lbrack \global\let]=\rbrack |
---|
5363 | \global\let& = \& |
---|
5364 | |
---|
5365 | \gdef\boldbrax{\let(=\opnr\let)=\clnr\let[=\lbrb\let]=\rbrb} |
---|
5366 | \gdef\magicamp{\let&=\amprm} |
---|
5367 | } |
---|
5368 | |
---|
5369 | \newcount\parencount |
---|
5370 | |
---|
5371 | % If we encounter &foo, then turn on ()-hacking afterwards |
---|
5372 | \newif\ifampseen |
---|
5373 | \def\amprm#1 {\ampseentrue{\bf\ }} |
---|
5374 | |
---|
5375 | \def\parenfont{% |
---|
5376 | \ifampseen |
---|
5377 | % At the first level, print parens in roman, |
---|
5378 | % otherwise use the default font. |
---|
5379 | \ifnum \parencount=1 \rm \fi |
---|
5380 | \else |
---|
5381 | % The \sf parens (in \boldbrax) actually are a little bolder than |
---|
5382 | % the contained text. This is especially needed for [ and ] . |
---|
5383 | \sf |
---|
5384 | \fi |
---|
5385 | } |
---|
5386 | \def\infirstlevel#1{% |
---|
5387 | \ifampseen |
---|
5388 | \ifnum\parencount=1 |
---|
5389 | #1% |
---|
5390 | \fi |
---|
5391 | \fi |
---|
5392 | } |
---|
5393 | \def\bfafterword#1 {#1 \bf} |
---|
5394 | |
---|
5395 | \def\opnr{% |
---|
5396 | \global\advance\parencount by 1 |
---|
5397 | {\parenfont(}% |
---|
5398 | \infirstlevel \bfafterword |
---|
5399 | } |
---|
5400 | \def\clnr{% |
---|
5401 | {\parenfont)}% |
---|
5402 | \infirstlevel \sl |
---|
5403 | \global\advance\parencount by -1 |
---|
5404 | } |
---|
5405 | |
---|
5406 | \newcount\brackcount |
---|
5407 | \def\lbrb{% |
---|
5408 | \global\advance\brackcount by 1 |
---|
5409 | {\bf[}% |
---|
5410 | } |
---|
5411 | \def\rbrb{% |
---|
5412 | {\bf]}% |
---|
5413 | \global\advance\brackcount by -1 |
---|
5414 | } |
---|
5415 | |
---|
5416 | \def\checkparencounts{% |
---|
5417 | \ifnum\parencount=0 \else \badparencount \fi |
---|
5418 | \ifnum\brackcount=0 \else \badbrackcount \fi |
---|
5419 | } |
---|
5420 | \def\badparencount{% |
---|
5421 | \errmessage{Unbalanced parentheses in @def}% |
---|
5422 | \global\parencount=0 |
---|
5423 | } |
---|
5424 | \def\badbrackcount{% |
---|
5425 | \errmessage{Unbalanced square braces in @def}% |
---|
5426 | \global\brackcount=0 |
---|
5427 | } |
---|
5428 | |
---|
5429 | |
---|
5430 | \message{macros,} |
---|
5431 | % @macro. |
---|
5432 | |
---|
5433 | % To do this right we need a feature of e-TeX, \scantokens, |
---|
5434 | % which we arrange to emulate with a temporary file in ordinary TeX. |
---|
5435 | \ifx\eTeXversion\undefined |
---|
5436 | \newwrite\macscribble |
---|
5437 | \def\scantokens#1{% |
---|
5438 | \toks0={#1\endinput}% |
---|
5439 | \immediate\openout\macscribble=\jobname.tmp |
---|
5440 | \immediate\write\macscribble{\the\toks0}% |
---|
5441 | \immediate\closeout\macscribble |
---|
5442 | \input \jobname.tmp |
---|
5443 | } |
---|
5444 | \fi |
---|
5445 | |
---|
5446 | \def\scanmacro#1{% |
---|
5447 | \begingroup |
---|
5448 | \newlinechar`\^^M |
---|
5449 | \let\xeatspaces\eatspaces |
---|
5450 | % Undo catcode changes of \startcontents and \doprintindex |
---|
5451 | \catcode`\@=0 \catcode`\\=\other \escapechar=`\@ |
---|
5452 | % ... and \example |
---|
5453 | \spaceisspace |
---|
5454 | % |
---|
5455 | % Append \endinput to make sure that TeX does not see the ending newline. |
---|
5456 | % |
---|
5457 | % I've verified that it is necessary both for e-TeX and for ordinary TeX |
---|
5458 | % --kasal, 29nov03 |
---|
5459 | \scantokens{#1\endinput}% |
---|
5460 | \endgroup |
---|
5461 | } |
---|
5462 | |
---|
5463 | \newcount\paramno % Count of parameters |
---|
5464 | \newtoks\macname % Macro name |
---|
5465 | \newif\ifrecursive % Is it recursive? |
---|
5466 | \def\macrolist{} % List of all defined macros in the form |
---|
5467 | % \do\macro1\do\macro2... |
---|
5468 | |
---|
5469 | % Utility routines. |
---|
5470 | % This does \let #1 = #2, except with \csnames. |
---|
5471 | \def\cslet#1#2{% |
---|
5472 | \expandafter\expandafter |
---|
5473 | \expandafter\let |
---|
5474 | \expandafter\expandafter |
---|
5475 | \csname#1\endcsname |
---|
5476 | \csname#2\endcsname} |
---|
5477 | |
---|
5478 | % Trim leading and trailing spaces off a string. |
---|
5479 | % Concepts from aro-bend problem 15 (see CTAN). |
---|
5480 | {\catcode`\@=11 |
---|
5481 | \gdef\eatspaces #1{\expandafter\trim@\expandafter{#1 }} |
---|
5482 | \gdef\trim@ #1{\trim@@ @#1 @ #1 @ @@} |
---|
5483 | \gdef\trim@@ #1@ #2@ #3@@{\trim@@@\empty #2 @} |
---|
5484 | \def\unbrace#1{#1} |
---|
5485 | \unbrace{\gdef\trim@@@ #1 } #2@{#1} |
---|
5486 | } |
---|
5487 | |
---|
5488 | % Trim a single trailing ^^M off a string. |
---|
5489 | {\catcode`\^^M=\other \catcode`\Q=3% |
---|
5490 | \gdef\eatcr #1{\eatcra #1Q^^MQ}% |
---|
5491 | \gdef\eatcra#1^^MQ{\eatcrb#1Q}% |
---|
5492 | \gdef\eatcrb#1Q#2Q{#1}% |
---|
5493 | } |
---|
5494 | |
---|
5495 | % Macro bodies are absorbed as an argument in a context where |
---|
5496 | % all characters are catcode 10, 11 or 12, except \ which is active |
---|
5497 | % (as in normal texinfo). It is necessary to change the definition of \. |
---|
5498 | |
---|
5499 | % It's necessary to have hard CRs when the macro is executed. This is |
---|
5500 | % done by making ^^M (\endlinechar) catcode 12 when reading the macro |
---|
5501 | % body, and then making it the \newlinechar in \scanmacro. |
---|
5502 | |
---|
5503 | \def\macrobodyctxt{% |
---|
5504 | \catcode`\~=\other |
---|
5505 | \catcode`\^=\other |
---|
5506 | \catcode`\_=\other |
---|
5507 | \catcode`\|=\other |
---|
5508 | \catcode`\<=\other |
---|
5509 | \catcode`\>=\other |
---|
5510 | \catcode`\+=\other |
---|
5511 | \catcode`\{=\other |
---|
5512 | \catcode`\}=\other |
---|
5513 | \catcode`\@=\other |
---|
5514 | \catcode`\^^M=\other |
---|
5515 | \usembodybackslash} |
---|
5516 | |
---|
5517 | \def\macroargctxt{% |
---|
5518 | \catcode`\~=\other |
---|
5519 | \catcode`\^=\other |
---|
5520 | \catcode`\_=\other |
---|
5521 | \catcode`\|=\other |
---|
5522 | \catcode`\<=\other |
---|
5523 | \catcode`\>=\other |
---|
5524 | \catcode`\+=\other |
---|
5525 | \catcode`\@=\other |
---|
5526 | \catcode`\\=\other} |
---|
5527 | |
---|
5528 | % \mbodybackslash is the definition of \ in @macro bodies. |
---|
5529 | % It maps \foo\ => \csname macarg.foo\endcsname => #N |
---|
5530 | % where N is the macro parameter number. |
---|
5531 | % We define \csname macarg.\endcsname to be \realbackslash, so |
---|
5532 | % \\ in macro replacement text gets you a backslash. |
---|
5533 | |
---|
5534 | {\catcode`@=0 @catcode`@\=@active |
---|
5535 | @gdef@usembodybackslash{@let\=@mbodybackslash} |
---|
5536 | @gdef@mbodybackslash#1\{@csname macarg.#1@endcsname} |
---|
5537 | } |
---|
5538 | \expandafter\def\csname macarg.\endcsname{\realbackslash} |
---|
5539 | |
---|
5540 | \def\macro{\recursivefalse\parsearg\macroxxx} |
---|
5541 | \def\rmacro{\recursivetrue\parsearg\macroxxx} |
---|
5542 | |
---|
5543 | \def\macroxxx#1{% |
---|
5544 | \getargs{#1}% now \macname is the macname and \argl the arglist |
---|
5545 | \ifx\argl\empty % no arguments |
---|
5546 | \paramno=0% |
---|
5547 | \else |
---|
5548 | \expandafter\parsemargdef \argl;% |
---|
5549 | \fi |
---|
5550 | \if1\csname ismacro.\the\macname\endcsname |
---|
5551 | \message{Warning: redefining \the\macname}% |
---|
5552 | \else |
---|
5553 | \expandafter\ifx\csname \the\macname\endcsname \relax |
---|
5554 | \else \errmessage{Macro name \the\macname\space already defined}\fi |
---|
5555 | \global\cslet{macsave.\the\macname}{\the\macname}% |
---|
5556 | \global\expandafter\let\csname ismacro.\the\macname\endcsname=1% |
---|
5557 | % Add the macroname to \macrolist |
---|
5558 | \toks0 = \expandafter{\macrolist\do}% |
---|
5559 | \xdef\macrolist{\the\toks0 |
---|
5560 | \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname\endcsname}% |
---|
5561 | \fi |
---|
5562 | \begingroup \macrobodyctxt |
---|
5563 | \ifrecursive \expandafter\parsermacbody |
---|
5564 | \else \expandafter\parsemacbody |
---|
5565 | \fi} |
---|
5566 | |
---|
5567 | \parseargdef\unmacro{% |
---|
5568 | \if1\csname ismacro.#1\endcsname |
---|
5569 | \global\cslet{#1}{macsave.#1}% |
---|
5570 | \global\expandafter\let \csname ismacro.#1\endcsname=0% |
---|
5571 | % Remove the macro name from \macrolist: |
---|
5572 | \begingroup |
---|
5573 | \expandafter\let\csname#1\endcsname \relax |
---|
5574 | \let\do\unmacrodo |
---|
5575 | \xdef\macrolist{\macrolist}% |
---|
5576 | \endgroup |
---|
5577 | \else |
---|
5578 | \errmessage{Macro #1 not defined}% |
---|
5579 | \fi |
---|
5580 | } |
---|
5581 | |
---|
5582 | % Called by \do from \dounmacro on each macro. The idea is to omit any |
---|
5583 | % macro definitions that have been changed to \relax. |
---|
5584 | % |
---|
5585 | \def\unmacrodo#1{% |
---|
5586 | \ifx#1\relax |
---|
5587 | % remove this |
---|
5588 | \else |
---|
5589 | \noexpand\do \noexpand #1% |
---|
5590 | \fi |
---|
5591 | } |
---|
5592 | |
---|
5593 | % This makes use of the obscure feature that if the last token of a |
---|
5594 | % <parameter list> is #, then the preceding argument is delimited by |
---|
5595 | % an opening brace, and that opening brace is not consumed. |
---|
5596 | \def\getargs#1{\getargsxxx#1{}} |
---|
5597 | \def\getargsxxx#1#{\getmacname #1 \relax\getmacargs} |
---|
5598 | \def\getmacname #1 #2\relax{\macname={#1}} |
---|
5599 | \def\getmacargs#1{\def\argl{#1}} |
---|
5600 | |
---|
5601 | % Parse the optional {params} list. Set up \paramno and \paramlist |
---|
5602 | % so \defmacro knows what to do. Define \macarg.blah for each blah |
---|
5603 | % in the params list, to be ##N where N is the position in that list. |
---|
5604 | % That gets used by \mbodybackslash (above). |
---|
5605 | |
---|
5606 | % We need to get `macro parameter char #' into several definitions. |
---|
5607 | % The technique used is stolen from LaTeX: let \hash be something |
---|
5608 | % unexpandable, insert that wherever you need a #, and then redefine |
---|
5609 | % it to # just before using the token list produced. |
---|
5610 | % |
---|
5611 | % The same technique is used to protect \eatspaces till just before |
---|
5612 | % the macro is used. |
---|
5613 | |
---|
5614 | \def\parsemargdef#1;{\paramno=0\def\paramlist{}% |
---|
5615 | \let\hash\relax\let\xeatspaces\relax\parsemargdefxxx#1,;,} |
---|
5616 | \def\parsemargdefxxx#1,{% |
---|
5617 | \if#1;\let\next=\relax |
---|
5618 | \else \let\next=\parsemargdefxxx |
---|
5619 | \advance\paramno by 1% |
---|
5620 | \expandafter\edef\csname macarg.\eatspaces{#1}\endcsname |
---|
5621 | {\xeatspaces{\hash\the\paramno}}% |
---|
5622 | \edef\paramlist{\paramlist\hash\the\paramno,}% |
---|
5623 | \fi\next} |
---|
5624 | |
---|
5625 | % These two commands read recursive and nonrecursive macro bodies. |
---|
5626 | % (They're different since rec and nonrec macros end differently.) |
---|
5627 | |
---|
5628 | \long\def\parsemacbody#1@end macro% |
---|
5629 | {\xdef\temp{\eatcr{#1}}\endgroup\defmacro}% |
---|
5630 | \long\def\parsermacbody#1@end rmacro% |
---|
5631 | {\xdef\temp{\eatcr{#1}}\endgroup\defmacro}% |
---|
5632 | |
---|
5633 | % This defines the macro itself. There are six cases: recursive and |
---|
5634 | % nonrecursive macros of zero, one, and many arguments. |
---|
5635 | % Much magic with \expandafter here. |
---|
5636 | % \xdef is used so that macro definitions will survive the file |
---|
5637 | % they're defined in; @include reads the file inside a group. |
---|
5638 | \def\defmacro{% |
---|
5639 | \let\hash=##% convert placeholders to macro parameter chars |
---|
5640 | \ifrecursive |
---|
5641 | \ifcase\paramno |
---|
5642 | % 0 |
---|
5643 | \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% |
---|
5644 | \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}% |
---|
5645 | \or % 1 |
---|
5646 | \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% |
---|
5647 | \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt |
---|
5648 | \noexpand\braceorline |
---|
5649 | \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname}% |
---|
5650 | \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname##1{% |
---|
5651 | \egroup\noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}% |
---|
5652 | \else % many |
---|
5653 | \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% |
---|
5654 | \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt |
---|
5655 | \noexpand\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname}% |
---|
5656 | \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname##1{% |
---|
5657 | \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname ##1,}% |
---|
5658 | \expandafter\expandafter |
---|
5659 | \expandafter\xdef |
---|
5660 | \expandafter\expandafter |
---|
5661 | \csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname |
---|
5662 | \paramlist{\egroup\noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}% |
---|
5663 | \fi |
---|
5664 | \else |
---|
5665 | \ifcase\paramno |
---|
5666 | % 0 |
---|
5667 | \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% |
---|
5668 | \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}% |
---|
5669 | \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}% |
---|
5670 | \or % 1 |
---|
5671 | \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% |
---|
5672 | \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt |
---|
5673 | \noexpand\braceorline |
---|
5674 | \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname}% |
---|
5675 | \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname##1{% |
---|
5676 | \egroup |
---|
5677 | \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}% |
---|
5678 | \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}% |
---|
5679 | \else % many |
---|
5680 | \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% |
---|
5681 | \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt |
---|
5682 | \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname}% |
---|
5683 | \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname##1{% |
---|
5684 | \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname ##1,}% |
---|
5685 | \expandafter\expandafter |
---|
5686 | \expandafter\xdef |
---|
5687 | \expandafter\expandafter |
---|
5688 | \csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname |
---|
5689 | \paramlist{% |
---|
5690 | \egroup |
---|
5691 | \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}% |
---|
5692 | \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}% |
---|
5693 | \fi |
---|
5694 | \fi} |
---|
5695 | |
---|
5696 | \def\norecurse#1{\bgroup\cslet{#1}{macsave.#1}} |
---|
5697 | |
---|
5698 | % \braceorline decides whether the next nonwhitespace character is a |
---|
5699 | % {. If so it reads up to the closing }, if not, it reads the whole |
---|
5700 | % line. Whatever was read is then fed to the next control sequence |
---|
5701 | % as an argument (by \parsebrace or \parsearg) |
---|
5702 | \def\braceorline#1{\let\next=#1\futurelet\nchar\braceorlinexxx} |
---|
5703 | \def\braceorlinexxx{% |
---|
5704 | \ifx\nchar\bgroup\else |
---|
5705 | \expandafter\parsearg |
---|
5706 | \fi \next} |
---|
5707 | |
---|
5708 | % We mant to disable all macros during \shipout so that they are not |
---|
5709 | % expanded by \write. |
---|
5710 | \def\turnoffmacros{\begingroup \def\do##1{\let\noexpand##1=\relax}% |
---|
5711 | \edef\next{\macrolist}\expandafter\endgroup\next} |
---|
5712 | |
---|
5713 | |
---|
5714 | % @alias. |
---|
5715 | % We need some trickery to remove the optional spaces around the equal |
---|
5716 | % sign. Just make them active and then expand them all to nothing. |
---|
5717 | \def\alias{\parseargusing\obeyspaces\aliasxxx} |
---|
5718 | \def\aliasxxx #1{\aliasyyy#1\relax} |
---|
5719 | \def\aliasyyy #1=#2\relax{% |
---|
5720 | {% |
---|
5721 | \expandafter\let\obeyedspace=\empty |
---|
5722 | \xdef\next{\global\let\makecsname{#1}=\makecsname{#2}}% |
---|
5723 | }% |
---|
5724 | \next |
---|
5725 | } |
---|
5726 | |
---|
5727 | |
---|
5728 | \message{cross references,} |
---|
5729 | |
---|
5730 | \newwrite\auxfile |
---|
5731 | |
---|
5732 | \newif\ifhavexrefs % True if xref values are known. |
---|
5733 | \newif\ifwarnedxrefs % True if we warned once that they aren't known. |
---|
5734 | |
---|
5735 | % @inforef is relatively simple. |
---|
5736 | \def\inforef #1{\inforefzzz #1,,,,**} |
---|
5737 | \def\inforefzzz #1,#2,#3,#4**{\putwordSee{} \putwordInfo{} \putwordfile{} \file{\ignorespaces #3{}}, |
---|
5738 | node \samp{\ignorespaces#1{}}} |
---|
5739 | |
---|
5740 | % @node's only job in TeX is to define \lastnode, which is used in |
---|
5741 | % cross-references. |
---|
5742 | \parseargdef\node{\checkenv{}\nodexxx #1,\finishnodeparse} |
---|
5743 | \def\nodexxx#1,#2\finishnodeparse{\gdef\lastnode{#1}} |
---|
5744 | \let\nwnode=\node |
---|
5745 | \let\lastnode=\empty |
---|
5746 | |
---|
5747 | % Write a cross-reference definition for the current node. #1 is the |
---|
5748 | % type (Ynumbered, Yappendix, Ynothing). |
---|
5749 | % |
---|
5750 | \def\donoderef#1{% |
---|
5751 | \ifx\lastnode\empty\else |
---|
5752 | \setref{\lastnode}{#1}% |
---|
5753 | \global\let\lastnode=\empty |
---|
5754 | \fi |
---|
5755 | } |
---|
5756 | |
---|
5757 | % @anchor{NAME} -- define xref target at arbitrary point. |
---|
5758 | % |
---|
5759 | \newcount\savesfregister |
---|
5760 | % |
---|
5761 | \def\savesf{\relax \ifhmode \savesfregister=\spacefactor \fi} |
---|
5762 | \def\restoresf{\relax \ifhmode \spacefactor=\savesfregister \fi} |
---|
5763 | \def\anchor#1{\savesf \setref{#1}{Ynothing}\restoresf \ignorespaces} |
---|
5764 | |
---|
5765 | % \setref{NAME}{SNT} defines a cross-reference point NAME (a node or an |
---|
5766 | % anchor), which consists of three parts: |
---|
5767 | % 1) NAME-title - the current sectioning name taken from \thissection, |
---|
5768 | % or the anchor name. |
---|
5769 | % 2) NAME-snt - section number and type, passed as the SNT arg, or |
---|
5770 | % empty for anchors. |
---|
5771 | % 3) NAME-pg - the page number. |
---|
5772 | % |
---|
5773 | % This is called from \donoderef, \anchor, and \dofloat. In the case of |
---|
5774 | % floats, there is an additional part, which is not written here: |
---|
5775 | % 4) NAME-lof - the text as it should appear in a @listoffloats. |
---|
5776 | % |
---|
5777 | \def\setref#1#2{% |
---|
5778 | \pdfmkdest{#1}% |
---|
5779 | \iflinks |
---|
5780 | {% |
---|
5781 | \atdummies % preserve commands, but don't expand them |
---|
5782 | \turnoffactive |
---|
5783 | \otherbackslash |
---|
5784 | \edef\writexrdef##1##2{% |
---|
5785 | \write\auxfile{@xrdef{#1-% #1 of \setref, expanded by the \edef |
---|
5786 | ##1}{##2}}% these are parameters of \writexrdef |
---|
5787 | }% |
---|
5788 | \toks0 = \expandafter{\thissection}% |
---|
5789 | \immediate \writexrdef{title}{\the\toks0 }% |
---|
5790 | \immediate \writexrdef{snt}{\csname #2\endcsname}% \Ynumbered etc. |
---|
5791 | \writexrdef{pg}{\folio}% will be written later, during \shipout |
---|
5792 | }% |
---|
5793 | \fi |
---|
5794 | } |
---|
5795 | |
---|
5796 | % @xref, @pxref, and @ref generate cross-references. For \xrefX, #1 is |
---|
5797 | % the node name, #2 the name of the Info cross-reference, #3 the printed |
---|
5798 | % node name, #4 the name of the Info file, #5 the name of the printed |
---|
5799 | % manual. All but the node name can be omitted. |
---|
5800 | % |
---|
5801 | \def\pxref#1{\putwordsee{} \xrefX[#1,,,,,,,]} |
---|
5802 | \def\xref#1{\putwordSee{} \xrefX[#1,,,,,,,]} |
---|
5803 | \def\ref#1{\xrefX[#1,,,,,,,]} |
---|
5804 | \def\xrefX[#1,#2,#3,#4,#5,#6]{\begingroup |
---|
5805 | \unsepspaces |
---|
5806 | \def\printedmanual{\ignorespaces #5}% |
---|
5807 | \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #3}% |
---|
5808 | \setbox1=\hbox{\printedmanual\unskip}% |
---|
5809 | \setbox0=\hbox{\printedrefname\unskip}% |
---|
5810 | \ifdim \wd0 = 0pt |
---|
5811 | % No printed node name was explicitly given. |
---|
5812 | \expandafter\ifx\csname SETxref-automatic-section-title\endcsname\relax |
---|
5813 | % Use the node name inside the square brackets. |
---|
5814 | \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}% |
---|
5815 | \else |
---|
5816 | % Use the actual chapter/section title appear inside |
---|
5817 | % the square brackets. Use the real section title if we have it. |
---|
5818 | \ifdim \wd1 > 0pt |
---|
5819 | % It is in another manual, so we don't have it. |
---|
5820 | \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}% |
---|
5821 | \else |
---|
5822 | \ifhavexrefs |
---|
5823 | % We know the real title if we have the xref values. |
---|
5824 | \def\printedrefname{\refx{#1-title}{}}% |
---|
5825 | \else |
---|
5826 | % Otherwise just copy the Info node name. |
---|
5827 | \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}% |
---|
5828 | \fi% |
---|
5829 | \fi |
---|
5830 | \fi |
---|
5831 | \fi |
---|
5832 | % |
---|
5833 | % Make link in pdf output. |
---|
5834 | \ifpdf |
---|
5835 | \leavevmode |
---|
5836 | \getfilename{#4}% |
---|
5837 | {\turnoffactive \otherbackslash |
---|
5838 | \ifnum\filenamelength>0 |
---|
5839 | \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}% |
---|
5840 | goto file{\the\filename.pdf} name{#1}% |
---|
5841 | \else |
---|
5842 | \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}% |
---|
5843 | goto name{\pdfmkpgn{#1}}% |
---|
5844 | \fi |
---|
5845 | }% |
---|
5846 | \linkcolor |
---|
5847 | \fi |
---|
5848 | % |
---|
5849 | % Float references are printed completely differently: "Figure 1.2" |
---|
5850 | % instead of "[somenode], p.3". We distinguish them by the |
---|
5851 | % LABEL-title being set to a magic string. |
---|
5852 | {% |
---|
5853 | % Have to otherify everything special to allow the \csname to |
---|
5854 | % include an _ in the xref name, etc. |
---|
5855 | \indexnofonts |
---|
5856 | \turnoffactive |
---|
5857 | \otherbackslash |
---|
5858 | \expandafter\global\expandafter\let\expandafter\Xthisreftitle |
---|
5859 | \csname XR#1-title\endcsname |
---|
5860 | }% |
---|
5861 | \iffloat\Xthisreftitle |
---|
5862 | % If the user specified the print name (third arg) to the ref, |
---|
5863 | % print it instead of our usual "Figure 1.2". |
---|
5864 | \ifdim\wd0 = 0pt |
---|
5865 | \refx{#1-snt}% |
---|
5866 | \else |
---|
5867 | \printedrefname |
---|
5868 | \fi |
---|
5869 | % |
---|
5870 | % if the user also gave the printed manual name (fifth arg), append |
---|
5871 | % "in MANUALNAME". |
---|
5872 | \ifdim \wd1 > 0pt |
---|
5873 | \space \putwordin{} \cite{\printedmanual}% |
---|
5874 | \fi |
---|
5875 | \else |
---|
5876 | % node/anchor (non-float) references. |
---|
5877 | % |
---|
5878 | % If we use \unhbox0 and \unhbox1 to print the node names, TeX does not |
---|
5879 | % insert empty discretionaries after hyphens, which means that it will |
---|
5880 | % not find a line break at a hyphen in a node names. Since some manuals |
---|
5881 | % are best written with fairly long node names, containing hyphens, this |
---|
5882 | % is a loss. Therefore, we give the text of the node name again, so it |
---|
5883 | % is as if TeX is seeing it for the first time. |
---|
5884 | \ifdim \wd1 > 0pt |
---|
5885 | \putwordsection{} ``\printedrefname'' \putwordin{} \cite{\printedmanual}% |
---|
5886 | \else |
---|
5887 | % _ (for example) has to be the character _ for the purposes of the |
---|
5888 | % control sequence corresponding to the node, but it has to expand |
---|
5889 | % into the usual \leavevmode...\vrule stuff for purposes of |
---|
5890 | % printing. So we \turnoffactive for the \refx-snt, back on for the |
---|
5891 | % printing, back off for the \refx-pg. |
---|
5892 | {\turnoffactive \otherbackslash |
---|
5893 | % Only output a following space if the -snt ref is nonempty; for |
---|
5894 | % @unnumbered and @anchor, it won't be. |
---|
5895 | \setbox2 = \hbox{\ignorespaces \refx{#1-snt}{}}% |
---|
5896 | \ifdim \wd2 > 0pt \refx{#1-snt}\space\fi |
---|
5897 | }% |
---|
5898 | % output the `[mynode]' via a macro so it can be overridden. |
---|
5899 | \xrefprintnodename\printedrefname |
---|
5900 | % |
---|
5901 | % But we always want a comma and a space: |
---|
5902 | ,\space |
---|
5903 | % |
---|
5904 | % output the `page 3'. |
---|
5905 | \turnoffactive \otherbackslash \putwordpage\tie\refx{#1-pg}{}% |
---|
5906 | \fi |
---|
5907 | \fi |
---|
5908 | \endlink |
---|
5909 | \endgroup} |
---|
5910 | |
---|
5911 | % This macro is called from \xrefX for the `[nodename]' part of xref |
---|
5912 | % output. It's a separate macro only so it can be changed more easily, |
---|
5913 | % since square brackets don't work well in some documents. Particularly |
---|
5914 | % one that Bob is working on :). |
---|
5915 | % |
---|
5916 | \def\xrefprintnodename#1{[#1]} |
---|
5917 | |
---|
5918 | % Things referred to by \setref. |
---|
5919 | % |
---|
5920 | \def\Ynothing{} |
---|
5921 | \def\Yomitfromtoc{} |
---|
5922 | \def\Ynumbered{% |
---|
5923 | \ifnum\secno=0 |
---|
5924 | \putwordChapter@tie \the\chapno |
---|
5925 | \else \ifnum\subsecno=0 |
---|
5926 | \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno |
---|
5927 | \else \ifnum\subsubsecno=0 |
---|
5928 | \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno |
---|
5929 | \else |
---|
5930 | \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno |
---|
5931 | \fi\fi\fi |
---|
5932 | } |
---|
5933 | \def\Yappendix{% |
---|
5934 | \ifnum\secno=0 |
---|
5935 | \putwordAppendix@tie @char\the\appendixno{}% |
---|
5936 | \else \ifnum\subsecno=0 |
---|
5937 | \putwordSection@tie @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno |
---|
5938 | \else \ifnum\subsubsecno=0 |
---|
5939 | \putwordSection@tie @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno |
---|
5940 | \else |
---|
5941 | \putwordSection@tie |
---|
5942 | @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno |
---|
5943 | \fi\fi\fi |
---|
5944 | } |
---|
5945 | |
---|
5946 | % Define \refx{NAME}{SUFFIX} to reference a cross-reference string named NAME. |
---|
5947 | % If its value is nonempty, SUFFIX is output afterward. |
---|
5948 | % |
---|
5949 | \def\refx#1#2{% |
---|
5950 | {% |
---|
5951 | \indexnofonts |
---|
5952 | \otherbackslash |
---|
5953 | \expandafter\global\expandafter\let\expandafter\thisrefX |
---|
5954 | \csname XR#1\endcsname |
---|
5955 | }% |
---|
5956 | \ifx\thisrefX\relax |
---|
5957 | % If not defined, say something at least. |
---|
5958 | \angleleft un\-de\-fined\angleright |
---|
5959 | \iflinks |
---|
5960 | \ifhavexrefs |
---|
5961 | \message{\linenumber Undefined cross reference `#1'.}% |
---|
5962 | \else |
---|
5963 | \ifwarnedxrefs\else |
---|
5964 | \global\warnedxrefstrue |
---|
5965 | \message{Cross reference values unknown; you must run TeX again.}% |
---|
5966 | \fi |
---|
5967 | \fi |
---|
5968 | \fi |
---|
5969 | \else |
---|
5970 | % It's defined, so just use it. |
---|
5971 | \thisrefX |
---|
5972 | \fi |
---|
5973 | #2% Output the suffix in any case. |
---|
5974 | } |
---|
5975 | |
---|
5976 | % This is the macro invoked by entries in the aux file. Usually it's |
---|
5977 | % just a \def (we prepend XR to the control sequence name to avoid |
---|
5978 | % collisions). But if this is a float type, we have more work to do. |
---|
5979 | % |
---|
5980 | \def\xrdef#1#2{% |
---|
5981 | \expandafter\gdef\csname XR#1\endcsname{#2}% remember this xref value. |
---|
5982 | % |
---|
5983 | % Was that xref control sequence that we just defined for a float? |
---|
5984 | \expandafter\iffloat\csname XR#1\endcsname |
---|
5985 | % it was a float, and we have the (safe) float type in \iffloattype. |
---|
5986 | \expandafter\let\expandafter\floatlist |
---|
5987 | \csname floatlist\iffloattype\endcsname |
---|
5988 | % |
---|
5989 | % Is this the first time we've seen this float type? |
---|
5990 | \expandafter\ifx\floatlist\relax |
---|
5991 | \toks0 = {\do}% yes, so just \do |
---|
5992 | \else |
---|
5993 | % had it before, so preserve previous elements in list. |
---|
5994 | \toks0 = \expandafter{\floatlist\do}% |
---|
5995 | \fi |
---|
5996 | % |
---|
5997 | % Remember this xref in the control sequence \floatlistFLOATTYPE, |
---|
5998 | % for later use in \listoffloats. |
---|
5999 | \expandafter\xdef\csname floatlist\iffloattype\endcsname{\the\toks0{#1}}% |
---|
6000 | \fi |
---|
6001 | } |
---|
6002 | |
---|
6003 | % Read the last existing aux file, if any. No error if none exists. |
---|
6004 | % |
---|
6005 | \def\tryauxfile{% |
---|
6006 | \openin 1 \jobname.aux |
---|
6007 | \ifeof 1 \else |
---|
6008 | \readauxfile |
---|
6009 | \global\havexrefstrue |
---|
6010 | \fi |
---|
6011 | \closein 1 |
---|
6012 | } |
---|
6013 | |
---|
6014 | \def\readauxfile{\begingroup |
---|
6015 | \catcode`\^^@=\other |
---|
6016 | \catcode`\^^A=\other |
---|
6017 | \catcode`\^^B=\other |
---|
6018 | \catcode`\^^C=\other |
---|
6019 | \catcode`\^^D=\other |
---|
6020 | \catcode`\^^E=\other |
---|
6021 | \catcode`\^^F=\other |
---|
6022 | \catcode`\^^G=\other |
---|
6023 | \catcode`\^^H=\other |
---|
6024 | \catcode`\^^K=\other |
---|
6025 | \catcode`\^^L=\other |
---|
6026 | \catcode`\^^N=\other |
---|
6027 | \catcode`\^^P=\other |
---|
6028 | \catcode`\^^Q=\other |
---|
6029 | \catcode`\^^R=\other |
---|
6030 | \catcode`\^^S=\other |
---|
6031 | \catcode`\^^T=\other |
---|
6032 | \catcode`\^^U=\other |
---|
6033 | \catcode`\^^V=\other |
---|
6034 | \catcode`\^^W=\other |
---|
6035 | \catcode`\^^X=\other |
---|
6036 | \catcode`\^^Z=\other |
---|
6037 | \catcode`\^^[=\other |
---|
6038 | \catcode`\^^\=\other |
---|
6039 | \catcode`\^^]=\other |
---|
6040 | \catcode`\^^^=\other |
---|
6041 | \catcode`\^^_=\other |
---|
6042 | % It was suggested to set the catcode of ^ to 7, which would allow ^^e4 etc. |
---|
6043 | % in xref tags, i.e., node names. But since ^^e4 notation isn't |
---|
6044 | % supported in the main text, it doesn't seem desirable. Furthermore, |
---|
6045 | % that is not enough: for node names that actually contain a ^ |
---|
6046 | % character, we would end up writing a line like this: 'xrdef {'hat |
---|
6047 | % b-title}{'hat b} and \xrdef does a \csname...\endcsname on the first |
---|
6048 | % argument, and \hat is not an expandable control sequence. It could |
---|
6049 | % all be worked out, but why? Either we support ^^ or we don't. |
---|
6050 | % |
---|
6051 | % The other change necessary for this was to define \auxhat: |
---|
6052 | % \def\auxhat{\def^{'hat }}% extra space so ok if followed by letter |
---|
6053 | % and then to call \auxhat in \setq. |
---|
6054 | % |
---|
6055 | \catcode`\^=\other |
---|
6056 | % |
---|
6057 | % Special characters. Should be turned off anyway, but... |
---|
6058 | \catcode`\~=\other |
---|
6059 | \catcode`\[=\other |
---|
6060 | \catcode`\]=\other |
---|
6061 | \catcode`\"=\other |
---|
6062 | \catcode`\_=\other |
---|
6063 | \catcode`\|=\other |
---|
6064 | \catcode`\<=\other |
---|
6065 | \catcode`\>=\other |
---|
6066 | \catcode`\$=\other |
---|
6067 | \catcode`\#=\other |
---|
6068 | \catcode`\&=\other |
---|
6069 | \catcode`\%=\other |
---|
6070 | \catcode`+=\other % avoid \+ for paranoia even though we've turned it off |
---|
6071 | % |
---|
6072 | % This is to support \ in node names and titles, since the \ |
---|
6073 | % characters end up in a \csname. It's easier than |
---|
6074 | % leaving it active and making its active definition an actual \ |
---|
6075 | % character. What I don't understand is why it works in the *value* |
---|
6076 | % of the xrdef. Seems like it should be a catcode12 \, and that |
---|
6077 | % should not typeset properly. But it works, so I'm moving on for |
---|
6078 | % now. --karl, 15jan04. |
---|
6079 | \catcode`\\=\other |
---|
6080 | % |
---|
6081 | % Make the characters 128-255 be printing characters. |
---|
6082 | {% |
---|
6083 | \count 1=128 |
---|
6084 | \def\loop{% |
---|
6085 | \catcode\count 1=\other |
---|
6086 | \advance\count 1 by 1 |
---|
6087 | \ifnum \count 1<256 \loop \fi |
---|
6088 | }% |
---|
6089 | }% |
---|
6090 | % |
---|
6091 | % @ is our escape character in .aux files, and we need braces. |
---|
6092 | \catcode`\{=1 |
---|
6093 | \catcode`\}=2 |
---|
6094 | \catcode`\@=0 |
---|
6095 | % |
---|
6096 | \input \jobname.aux |
---|
6097 | \endgroup} |
---|
6098 | |
---|
6099 | |
---|
6100 | \message{insertions,} |
---|
6101 | % including footnotes. |
---|
6102 | |
---|
6103 | \newcount \footnoteno |
---|
6104 | |
---|
6105 | % The trailing space in the following definition for supereject is |
---|
6106 | % vital for proper filling; pages come out unaligned when you do a |
---|
6107 | % pagealignmacro call if that space before the closing brace is |
---|
6108 | % removed. (Generally, numeric constants should always be followed by a |
---|
6109 | % space to prevent strange expansion errors.) |
---|
6110 | \def\supereject{\par\penalty -20000\footnoteno =0 } |
---|
6111 | |
---|
6112 | % @footnotestyle is meaningful for info output only. |
---|
6113 | \let\footnotestyle=\comment |
---|
6114 | |
---|
6115 | {\catcode `\@=11 |
---|
6116 | % |
---|
6117 | % Auto-number footnotes. Otherwise like plain. |
---|
6118 | \gdef\footnote{% |
---|
6119 | \let\indent=\ptexindent |
---|
6120 | \let\noindent=\ptexnoindent |
---|
6121 | \global\advance\footnoteno by \@ne |
---|
6122 | \edef\thisfootno{$^{\the\footnoteno}$}% |
---|
6123 | % |
---|
6124 | % In case the footnote comes at the end of a sentence, preserve the |
---|
6125 | % extra spacing after we do the footnote number. |
---|
6126 | \let\@sf\empty |
---|
6127 | \ifhmode\edef\@sf{\spacefactor\the\spacefactor}\ptexslash\fi |
---|
6128 | % |
---|
6129 | % Remove inadvertent blank space before typesetting the footnote number. |
---|
6130 | \unskip |
---|
6131 | \thisfootno\@sf |
---|
6132 | \dofootnote |
---|
6133 | }% |
---|
6134 | |
---|
6135 | % Don't bother with the trickery in plain.tex to not require the |
---|
6136 | % footnote text as a parameter. Our footnotes don't need to be so general. |
---|
6137 | % |
---|
6138 | % Oh yes, they do; otherwise, @ifset (and anything else that uses |
---|
6139 | % \parseargline) fails inside footnotes because the tokens are fixed when |
---|
6140 | % the footnote is read. --karl, 16nov96. |
---|
6141 | % |
---|
6142 | \gdef\dofootnote{% |
---|
6143 | \insert\footins\bgroup |
---|
6144 | % We want to typeset this text as a normal paragraph, even if the |
---|
6145 | % footnote reference occurs in (for example) a display environment. |
---|
6146 | % So reset some parameters. |
---|
6147 | \hsize=\pagewidth |
---|
6148 | \interlinepenalty\interfootnotelinepenalty |
---|
6149 | \splittopskip\ht\strutbox % top baseline for broken footnotes |
---|
6150 | \splitmaxdepth\dp\strutbox |
---|
6151 | \floatingpenalty\@MM |
---|
6152 | \leftskip\z@skip |
---|
6153 | \rightskip\z@skip |
---|
6154 | \spaceskip\z@skip |
---|
6155 | \xspaceskip\z@skip |
---|
6156 | \parindent\defaultparindent |
---|
6157 | % |
---|
6158 | \smallfonts \rm |
---|
6159 | % |
---|
6160 | % Because we use hanging indentation in footnotes, a @noindent appears |
---|
6161 | % to exdent this text, so make it be a no-op. makeinfo does not use |
---|
6162 | % hanging indentation so @noindent can still be needed within footnote |
---|
6163 | % text after an @example or the like (not that this is good style). |
---|
6164 | \let\noindent = \relax |
---|
6165 | % |
---|
6166 | % Hang the footnote text off the number. Use \everypar in case the |
---|
6167 | % footnote extends for more than one paragraph. |
---|
6168 | \everypar = {\hang}% |
---|
6169 | \textindent{\thisfootno}% |
---|
6170 | % |
---|
6171 | % Don't crash into the line above the footnote text. Since this |
---|
6172 | % expands into a box, it must come within the paragraph, lest it |
---|
6173 | % provide a place where TeX can split the footnote. |
---|
6174 | \footstrut |
---|
6175 | \futurelet\next\fo@t |
---|
6176 | } |
---|
6177 | }%end \catcode `\@=11 |
---|
6178 | |
---|
6179 | % In case a @footnote appears in a vbox, save the footnote text and create |
---|
6180 | % the real \insert just after the vbox finished. Otherwise, the insertion |
---|
6181 | % would be lost. |
---|
6182 | % Similarily, if a @footnote appears inside an alignment, save the footnote |
---|
6183 | % text to a box and make the \insert when a row of the table is finished. |
---|
6184 | % And the same can be done for other insert classes. --kasal, 16nov03. |
---|
6185 | |
---|
6186 | % Replace the \insert primitive by a cheating macro. |
---|
6187 | % Deeper inside, just make sure that the saved insertions are not spilled |
---|
6188 | % out prematurely. |
---|
6189 | % |
---|
6190 | \def\startsavinginserts{% |
---|
6191 | \ifx \insert\ptexinsert |
---|
6192 | \let\insert\saveinsert |
---|
6193 | \else |
---|
6194 | \let\checkinserts\relax |
---|
6195 | \fi |
---|
6196 | } |
---|
6197 | |
---|
6198 | % This \insert replacement works for both \insert\footins{foo} and |
---|
6199 | % \insert\footins\bgroup foo\egroup, but it doesn't work for \insert27{foo}. |
---|
6200 | % |
---|
6201 | \def\saveinsert#1{% |
---|
6202 | \edef\next{\noexpand\savetobox \makeSAVEname#1}% |
---|
6203 | \afterassignment\next |
---|
6204 | % swallow the left brace |
---|
6205 | \let\temp = |
---|
6206 | } |
---|
6207 | \def\makeSAVEname#1{\makecsname{SAVE\expandafter\gobble\string#1}} |
---|
6208 | \def\savetobox#1{\global\setbox#1 = \vbox\bgroup \unvbox#1} |
---|
6209 | |
---|
6210 | \def\checksaveins#1{\ifvoid#1\else \placesaveins#1\fi} |
---|
6211 | |
---|
6212 | \def\placesaveins#1{% |
---|
6213 | \ptexinsert \csname\expandafter\gobblesave\string#1\endcsname |
---|
6214 | {\box#1}% |
---|
6215 | } |
---|
6216 | |
---|
6217 | % eat @SAVE -- beware, all of them have catcode \other: |
---|
6218 | { |
---|
6219 | \def\dospecials{\do S\do A\do V\do E} \uncatcodespecials % ;-) |
---|
6220 | \gdef\gobblesave @SAVE{} |
---|
6221 | } |
---|
6222 | |
---|
6223 | % initialization: |
---|
6224 | \def\newsaveins #1{% |
---|
6225 | \edef\next{\noexpand\newsaveinsX \makeSAVEname#1}% |
---|
6226 | \next |
---|
6227 | } |
---|
6228 | \def\newsaveinsX #1{% |
---|
6229 | \csname newbox\endcsname #1% |
---|
6230 | \expandafter\def\expandafter\checkinserts\expandafter{\checkinserts |
---|
6231 | \checksaveins #1}% |
---|
6232 | } |
---|
6233 | |
---|
6234 | % initialize: |
---|
6235 | \let\checkinserts\empty |
---|
6236 | \newsaveins\footins |
---|
6237 | \newsaveins\margin |
---|
6238 | |
---|
6239 | |
---|
6240 | % @image. We use the macros from epsf.tex to support this. |
---|
6241 | % If epsf.tex is not installed and @image is used, we complain. |
---|
6242 | % |
---|
6243 | % Check for and read epsf.tex up front. If we read it only at @image |
---|
6244 | % time, we might be inside a group, and then its definitions would get |
---|
6245 | % undone and the next image would fail. |
---|
6246 | \openin 1 = epsf.tex |
---|
6247 | \ifeof 1 \else |
---|
6248 | % Do not bother showing banner with epsf.tex v2.7k (available in |
---|
6249 | % doc/epsf.tex and on ctan). |
---|
6250 | \def\epsfannounce{\toks0 = }% |
---|
6251 | \input epsf.tex |
---|
6252 | \fi |
---|
6253 | \closein 1 |
---|
6254 | % |
---|
6255 | % We will only complain once about lack of epsf.tex. |
---|
6256 | \newif\ifwarnednoepsf |
---|
6257 | \newhelp\noepsfhelp{epsf.tex must be installed for images to |
---|
6258 | work. It is also included in the Texinfo distribution, or you can get |
---|
6259 | it from ftp://tug.org/tex/epsf.tex.} |
---|
6260 | % |
---|
6261 | \def\image#1{% |
---|
6262 | \ifx\epsfbox\undefined |
---|
6263 | \ifwarnednoepsf \else |
---|
6264 | \errhelp = \noepsfhelp |
---|
6265 | \errmessage{epsf.tex not found, images will be ignored}% |
---|
6266 | \global\warnednoepsftrue |
---|
6267 | \fi |
---|
6268 | \else |
---|
6269 | \imagexxx #1,,,,,\finish |
---|
6270 | \fi |
---|
6271 | } |
---|
6272 | % |
---|
6273 | % Arguments to @image: |
---|
6274 | % #1 is (mandatory) image filename; we tack on .eps extension. |
---|
6275 | % #2 is (optional) width, #3 is (optional) height. |
---|
6276 | % #4 is (ignored optional) html alt text. |
---|
6277 | % #5 is (ignored optional) extension. |
---|
6278 | % #6 is just the usual extra ignored arg for parsing this stuff. |
---|
6279 | \newif\ifimagevmode |
---|
6280 | \def\imagexxx#1,#2,#3,#4,#5,#6\finish{\begingroup |
---|
6281 | \catcode`\^^M = 5 % in case we're inside an example |
---|
6282 | \normalturnoffactive % allow _ et al. in names |
---|
6283 | % If the image is by itself, center it. |
---|
6284 | \ifvmode |
---|
6285 | \imagevmodetrue |
---|
6286 | \nobreak\bigskip |
---|
6287 | % Usually we'll have text after the image which will insert |
---|
6288 | % \parskip glue, so insert it here too to equalize the space |
---|
6289 | % above and below. |
---|
6290 | \nobreak\vskip\parskip |
---|
6291 | \nobreak |
---|
6292 | \line\bgroup\hss |
---|
6293 | \fi |
---|
6294 | % |
---|
6295 | % Output the image. |
---|
6296 | \ifpdf |
---|
6297 | \dopdfimage{#1}{#2}{#3}% |
---|
6298 | \else |
---|
6299 | % \epsfbox itself resets \epsf?size at each figure. |
---|
6300 | \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \epsfxsize=#2\relax \fi |
---|
6301 | \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \epsfysize=#3\relax \fi |
---|
6302 | \epsfbox{#1.eps}% |
---|
6303 | \fi |
---|
6304 | % |
---|
6305 | \ifimagevmode \hss \egroup \bigbreak \fi % space after the image |
---|
6306 | \endgroup} |
---|
6307 | |
---|
6308 | |
---|
6309 | % @float FLOATTYPE,LOC ... @end float for displayed figures, tables, etc. |
---|
6310 | % We don't actually implement floating yet, we just plop the float "here". |
---|
6311 | % But it seemed the best name for the future. |
---|
6312 | % |
---|
6313 | \envparseargdef\float{\dofloat #1,,,\finish} |
---|
6314 | |
---|
6315 | % #1 is the optional FLOATTYPE, the text label for this float, typically |
---|
6316 | % "Figure", "Table", "Example", etc. Can't contain commas. If omitted, |
---|
6317 | % this float will not be numbered and cannot be referred to. |
---|
6318 | % |
---|
6319 | % #2 is the optional xref label. Also must be present for the float to |
---|
6320 | % be referable. |
---|
6321 | % |
---|
6322 | % #3 is the optional positioning argument; for now, it is ignored. It |
---|
6323 | % will somehow specify the positions allowed to float to (here, top, bottom). |
---|
6324 | % |
---|
6325 | % We keep a separate counter for each FLOATTYPE, which we reset at each |
---|
6326 | % chapter-level command. |
---|
6327 | \let\resetallfloatnos=\empty |
---|
6328 | % |
---|
6329 | \def\dofloat#1,#2,#3,#4\finish{% |
---|
6330 | \let\thiscaption=\empty |
---|
6331 | \let\thisshortcaption=\empty |
---|
6332 | % |
---|
6333 | % don't lose footnotes inside @float. |
---|
6334 | \startsavinginserts |
---|
6335 | % |
---|
6336 | % We can't be used inside a paragraph. |
---|
6337 | \par |
---|
6338 | % |
---|
6339 | \vtop\bgroup |
---|
6340 | \def\floattype{#1}% |
---|
6341 | \def\floatlabel{#2}% |
---|
6342 | \def\floatloc{#3}% we do nothing with this yet. |
---|
6343 | % |
---|
6344 | \ifx\floattype\empty |
---|
6345 | \let\safefloattype=\empty |
---|
6346 | \else |
---|
6347 | {% |
---|
6348 | % the floattype might have accents or other special characters, |
---|
6349 | % but we need to use it in a control sequence name. |
---|
6350 | \indexnofonts |
---|
6351 | \turnoffactive |
---|
6352 | \xdef\safefloattype{\floattype}% |
---|
6353 | }% |
---|
6354 | \fi |
---|
6355 | % |
---|
6356 | % If label is given but no type, we handle that as the empty type. |
---|
6357 | \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else |
---|
6358 | % We want each FLOATTYPE to be numbered separately (Figure 1, |
---|
6359 | % Table 1, Figure 2, ...). (And if no label, no number.) |
---|
6360 | % |
---|
6361 | \expandafter\getfloatno\csname\safefloattype floatno\endcsname |
---|
6362 | \global\advance\floatno by 1 |
---|
6363 | % |
---|
6364 | {% |
---|
6365 | % This magic value for \thissection is output by \setref as the |
---|
6366 | % XREFLABEL-title value. \xrefX uses it to distinguish float |
---|
6367 | % labels (which have a completely different output format) from |
---|
6368 | % node and anchor labels. And \xrdef uses it to construct the |
---|
6369 | % lists of floats. |
---|
6370 | % |
---|
6371 | \edef\thissection{\floatmagic=\safefloattype}% |
---|
6372 | \setref{\floatlabel}{Yfloat}% |
---|
6373 | }% |
---|
6374 | \fi |
---|
6375 | % |
---|
6376 | % start with \parskip glue, I guess. |
---|
6377 | \vskip\parskip |
---|
6378 | % |
---|
6379 | % Don't suppress indentation if a float happens to start a section. |
---|
6380 | \restorefirstparagraphindent |
---|
6381 | } |
---|
6382 | |
---|
6383 | % we have these possibilities: |
---|
6384 | % @float Foo,lbl & @caption{Cap}: Foo 1.1: Cap |
---|
6385 | % @float Foo,lbl & no caption: Foo 1.1 |
---|
6386 | % @float Foo & @caption{Cap}: Foo: Cap |
---|
6387 | % @float Foo & no caption: Foo |
---|
6388 | % @float ,lbl & Caption{Cap}: 1.1: Cap |
---|
6389 | % @float ,lbl & no caption: 1.1 |
---|
6390 | % @float & @caption{Cap}: Cap |
---|
6391 | % @float & no caption: |
---|
6392 | % |
---|
6393 | \def\Efloat{% |
---|
6394 | \let\floatident = \empty |
---|
6395 | % |
---|
6396 | % In all cases, if we have a float type, it comes first. |
---|
6397 | \ifx\floattype\empty \else \def\floatident{\floattype}\fi |
---|
6398 | % |
---|
6399 | % If we have an xref label, the number comes next. |
---|
6400 | \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else |
---|
6401 | \ifx\floattype\empty \else % if also had float type, need tie first. |
---|
6402 | \appendtomacro\floatident{\tie}% |
---|
6403 | \fi |
---|
6404 | % the number. |
---|
6405 | \appendtomacro\floatident{\chaplevelprefix\the\floatno}% |
---|
6406 | \fi |
---|
6407 | % |
---|
6408 | % Start the printed caption with what we've constructed in |
---|
6409 | % \floatident, but keep it separate; we need \floatident again. |
---|
6410 | \let\captionline = \floatident |
---|
6411 | % |
---|
6412 | \ifx\thiscaption\empty \else |
---|
6413 | \ifx\floatident\empty \else |
---|
6414 | \appendtomacro\captionline{: }% had ident, so need a colon between |
---|
6415 | \fi |
---|
6416 | % |
---|
6417 | % caption text. |
---|
6418 | \appendtomacro\captionline\thiscaption |
---|
6419 | \fi |
---|
6420 | % |
---|
6421 | % If we have anything to print, print it, with space before. |
---|
6422 | % Eventually this needs to become an \insert. |
---|
6423 | \ifx\captionline\empty \else |
---|
6424 | \vskip.5\parskip |
---|
6425 | \captionline |
---|
6426 | \fi |
---|
6427 | % |
---|
6428 | % If have an xref label, write the list of floats info. Do this |
---|
6429 | % after the caption, to avoid chance of it being a breakpoint. |
---|
6430 | \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else |
---|
6431 | % Write the text that goes in the lof to the aux file as |
---|
6432 | % \floatlabel-lof. Besides \floatident, we include the short |
---|
6433 | % caption if specified, else the full caption if specified, else nothing. |
---|
6434 | {% |
---|
6435 | \atdummies \turnoffactive \otherbackslash |
---|
6436 | \immediate\write\auxfile{@xrdef{\floatlabel-lof}{% |
---|
6437 | \floatident |
---|
6438 | \ifx\thisshortcaption\empty |
---|
6439 | \ifx\thiscaption\empty \else : \thiscaption \fi |
---|
6440 | \else |
---|
6441 | : \thisshortcaption |
---|
6442 | \fi |
---|
6443 | }}% |
---|
6444 | }% |
---|
6445 | \fi |
---|
6446 | % |
---|
6447 | % Space below caption, if we printed anything. |
---|
6448 | \ifx\printedsomething\empty \else \vskip\parskip \fi |
---|
6449 | \egroup % end of \vtop |
---|
6450 | \checkinserts |
---|
6451 | } |
---|
6452 | |
---|
6453 | % Append the tokens #2 to the definition of macro #1, not expanding either. |
---|
6454 | % |
---|
6455 | \newtoks\appendtomacroAtoks |
---|
6456 | \newtoks\appendtomacroBtoks |
---|
6457 | \def\appendtomacro#1#2{% |
---|
6458 | \appendtomacroAtoks = \expandafter{#1}% |
---|
6459 | \appendtomacroBtoks = {#2}% |
---|
6460 | \edef#1{\the\appendtomacroAtoks \the\appendtomacroBtoks}% |
---|
6461 | } |
---|
6462 | |
---|
6463 | % @caption, @shortcaption are easy. |
---|
6464 | % |
---|
6465 | \long\def\caption#1{\checkenv\float \def\thiscaption{#1}} |
---|
6466 | \def\shortcaption#1{\checkenv\float \def\thisshortcaption{#1}} |
---|
6467 | |
---|
6468 | % The parameter is the control sequence identifying the counter we are |
---|
6469 | % going to use. Create it if it doesn't exist and assign it to \floatno. |
---|
6470 | \def\getfloatno#1{% |
---|
6471 | \ifx#1\relax |
---|
6472 | % Haven't seen this figure type before. |
---|
6473 | \csname newcount\endcsname #1% |
---|
6474 | % |
---|
6475 | % Remember to reset this floatno at the next chap. |
---|
6476 | \expandafter\gdef\expandafter\resetallfloatnos |
---|
6477 | \expandafter{\resetallfloatnos #1=0 }% |
---|
6478 | \fi |
---|
6479 | \let\floatno#1% |
---|
6480 | } |
---|
6481 | |
---|
6482 | % \setref calls this to get the XREFLABEL-snt value. We want an @xref |
---|
6483 | % to the FLOATLABEL to expand to "Figure 3.1". We call \setref when we |
---|
6484 | % first read the @float command. |
---|
6485 | % |
---|
6486 | \def\Yfloat{\floattype@tie \chaplevelprefix\the\floatno}% |
---|
6487 | |
---|
6488 | % Magic string used for the XREFLABEL-title value, so \xrefX can |
---|
6489 | % distinguish floats from other xref types. |
---|
6490 | \def\floatmagic{!!float!!} |
---|
6491 | |
---|
6492 | % #1 is the control sequence we are passed; we expand into a conditional |
---|
6493 | % which is true if #1 represents a float ref. That is, the magic |
---|
6494 | % \thissection value which we \setref above. |
---|
6495 | % |
---|
6496 | \def\iffloat#1{\expandafter\doiffloat#1==\finish} |
---|
6497 | % |
---|
6498 | % #1 is (maybe) the \floatmagic string. If so, #2 will be the |
---|
6499 | % (safe) float type for this float. We set \iffloattype to #2. |
---|
6500 | % |
---|
6501 | \def\doiffloat#1=#2=#3\finish{% |
---|
6502 | \def\temp{#1}% |
---|
6503 | \def\iffloattype{#2}% |
---|
6504 | \ifx\temp\floatmagic |
---|
6505 | } |
---|
6506 | |
---|
6507 | % @listoffloats FLOATTYPE - print a list of floats like a table of contents. |
---|
6508 | % |
---|
6509 | \parseargdef\listoffloats{% |
---|
6510 | \def\floattype{#1}% floattype |
---|
6511 | {% |
---|
6512 | % the floattype might have accents or other special characters, |
---|
6513 | % but we need to use it in a control sequence name. |
---|
6514 | \indexnofonts |
---|
6515 | \turnoffactive |
---|
6516 | \xdef\safefloattype{\floattype}% |
---|
6517 | }% |
---|
6518 | % |
---|
6519 | % \xrdef saves the floats as a \do-list in \floatlistSAFEFLOATTYPE. |
---|
6520 | \expandafter\ifx\csname floatlist\safefloattype\endcsname \relax |
---|
6521 | \ifhavexrefs |
---|
6522 | % if the user said @listoffloats foo but never @float foo. |
---|
6523 | \message{\linenumber No `\safefloattype' floats to list.}% |
---|
6524 | \fi |
---|
6525 | \else |
---|
6526 | \begingroup |
---|
6527 | \leftskip=\tocindent % indent these entries like a toc |
---|
6528 | \let\do=\listoffloatsdo |
---|
6529 | \csname floatlist\safefloattype\endcsname |
---|
6530 | \endgroup |
---|
6531 | \fi |
---|
6532 | } |
---|
6533 | |
---|
6534 | % This is called on each entry in a list of floats. We're passed the |
---|
6535 | % xref label, in the form LABEL-title, which is how we save it in the |
---|
6536 | % aux file. We strip off the -title and look up \XRLABEL-lof, which |
---|
6537 | % has the text we're supposed to typeset here. |
---|
6538 | % |
---|
6539 | % Figures without xref labels will not be included in the list (since |
---|
6540 | % they won't appear in the aux file). |
---|
6541 | % |
---|
6542 | \def\listoffloatsdo#1{\listoffloatsdoentry#1\finish} |
---|
6543 | \def\listoffloatsdoentry#1-title\finish{{% |
---|
6544 | % Can't fully expand XR#1-lof because it can contain anything. Just |
---|
6545 | % pass the control sequence. On the other hand, XR#1-pg is just the |
---|
6546 | % page number, and we want to fully expand that so we can get a link |
---|
6547 | % in pdf output. |
---|
6548 | \toksA = \expandafter{\csname XR#1-lof\endcsname}% |
---|
6549 | % |
---|
6550 | % use the same \entry macro we use to generate the TOC and index. |
---|
6551 | \edef\writeentry{\noexpand\entry{\the\toksA}{\csname XR#1-pg\endcsname}}% |
---|
6552 | \writeentry |
---|
6553 | }} |
---|
6554 | |
---|
6555 | \message{localization,} |
---|
6556 | % and i18n. |
---|
6557 | |
---|
6558 | % @documentlanguage is usually given very early, just after |
---|
6559 | % @setfilename. If done too late, it may not override everything |
---|
6560 | % properly. Single argument is the language abbreviation. |
---|
6561 | % It would be nice if we could set up a hyphenation file here. |
---|
6562 | % |
---|
6563 | \parseargdef\documentlanguage{% |
---|
6564 | \tex % read txi-??.tex file in plain TeX. |
---|
6565 | % Read the file if it exists. |
---|
6566 | \openin 1 txi-#1.tex |
---|
6567 | \ifeof 1 |
---|
6568 | \errhelp = \nolanghelp |
---|
6569 | \errmessage{Cannot read language file txi-#1.tex}% |
---|
6570 | \else |
---|
6571 | \input txi-#1.tex |
---|
6572 | \fi |
---|
6573 | \closein 1 |
---|
6574 | \endgroup |
---|
6575 | } |
---|
6576 | \newhelp\nolanghelp{The given language definition file cannot be found or |
---|
6577 | is empty. Maybe you need to install it? In the current directory |
---|
6578 | should work if nowhere else does.} |
---|
6579 | |
---|
6580 | |
---|
6581 | % @documentencoding should change something in TeX eventually, most |
---|
6582 | % likely, but for now just recognize it. |
---|
6583 | \let\documentencoding = \comment |
---|
6584 | |
---|
6585 | |
---|
6586 | % Page size parameters. |
---|
6587 | % |
---|
6588 | \newdimen\defaultparindent \defaultparindent = 15pt |
---|
6589 | |
---|
6590 | \chapheadingskip = 15pt plus 4pt minus 2pt |
---|
6591 | \secheadingskip = 12pt plus 3pt minus 2pt |
---|
6592 | \subsecheadingskip = 9pt plus 2pt minus 2pt |
---|
6593 | |
---|
6594 | % Prevent underfull vbox error messages. |
---|
6595 | \vbadness = 10000 |
---|
6596 | |
---|
6597 | % Don't be so finicky about underfull hboxes, either. |
---|
6598 | \hbadness = 2000 |
---|
6599 | |
---|
6600 | % Following George Bush, just get rid of widows and orphans. |
---|
6601 | \widowpenalty=10000 |
---|
6602 | \clubpenalty=10000 |
---|
6603 | |
---|
6604 | % Use TeX 3.0's \emergencystretch to help line breaking, but if we're |
---|
6605 | % using an old version of TeX, don't do anything. We want the amount of |
---|
6606 | % stretch added to depend on the line length, hence the dependence on |
---|
6607 | % \hsize. We call this whenever the paper size is set. |
---|
6608 | % |
---|
6609 | \def\setemergencystretch{% |
---|
6610 | \ifx\emergencystretch\thisisundefined |
---|
6611 | % Allow us to assign to \emergencystretch anyway. |
---|
6612 | \def\emergencystretch{\dimen0}% |
---|
6613 | \else |
---|
6614 | \emergencystretch = .15\hsize |
---|
6615 | \fi |
---|
6616 | } |
---|
6617 | |
---|
6618 | % Parameters in order: 1) textheight; 2) textwidth; 3) voffset; |
---|
6619 | % 4) hoffset; 5) binding offset; 6) topskip; 7) physical page height; 8) |
---|
6620 | % physical page width. |
---|
6621 | % |
---|
6622 | % We also call \setleading{\textleading}, so the caller should define |
---|
6623 | % \textleading. The caller should also set \parskip. |
---|
6624 | % |
---|
6625 | \def\internalpagesizes#1#2#3#4#5#6#7#8{% |
---|
6626 | \voffset = #3\relax |
---|
6627 | \topskip = #6\relax |
---|
6628 | \splittopskip = \topskip |
---|
6629 | % |
---|
6630 | \vsize = #1\relax |
---|
6631 | \advance\vsize by \topskip |
---|
6632 | \outervsize = \vsize |
---|
6633 | \advance\outervsize by 2\topandbottommargin |
---|
6634 | \pageheight = \vsize |
---|
6635 | % |
---|
6636 | \hsize = #2\relax |
---|
6637 | \outerhsize = \hsize |
---|
6638 | \advance\outerhsize by 0.5in |
---|
6639 | \pagewidth = \hsize |
---|
6640 | % |
---|
6641 | \normaloffset = #4\relax |
---|
6642 | \bindingoffset = #5\relax |
---|
6643 | % |
---|
6644 | \ifpdf |
---|
6645 | \pdfpageheight #7\relax |
---|
6646 | \pdfpagewidth #8\relax |
---|
6647 | \fi |
---|
6648 | % |
---|
6649 | \setleading{\textleading} |
---|
6650 | % |
---|
6651 | \parindent = \defaultparindent |
---|
6652 | \setemergencystretch |
---|
6653 | } |
---|
6654 | |
---|
6655 | % @letterpaper (the default). |
---|
6656 | \def\letterpaper{{\globaldefs = 1 |
---|
6657 | \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt |
---|
6658 | \textleading = 13.2pt |
---|
6659 | % |
---|
6660 | % If page is nothing but text, make it come out even. |
---|
6661 | \internalpagesizes{46\baselineskip}{6in}% |
---|
6662 | {\voffset}{.25in}% |
---|
6663 | {\bindingoffset}{36pt}% |
---|
6664 | {11in}{8.5in}% |
---|
6665 | }} |
---|
6666 | |
---|
6667 | % Use @smallbook to reset parameters for 7x9.5 (or so) format. |
---|
6668 | \def\smallbook{{\globaldefs = 1 |
---|
6669 | \parskip = 2pt plus 1pt |
---|
6670 | \textleading = 12pt |
---|
6671 | % |
---|
6672 | \internalpagesizes{7.5in}{5in}% |
---|
6673 | {\voffset}{.25in}% |
---|
6674 | {\bindingoffset}{16pt}% |
---|
6675 | {9.25in}{7in}% |
---|
6676 | % |
---|
6677 | \lispnarrowing = 0.3in |
---|
6678 | \tolerance = 700 |
---|
6679 | \hfuzz = 1pt |
---|
6680 | \contentsrightmargin = 0pt |
---|
6681 | \defbodyindent = .5cm |
---|
6682 | }} |
---|
6683 | |
---|
6684 | % Use @afourpaper to print on European A4 paper. |
---|
6685 | \def\afourpaper{{\globaldefs = 1 |
---|
6686 | \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt |
---|
6687 | \textleading = 13.2pt |
---|
6688 | % |
---|
6689 | % Double-side printing via postscript on Laserjet 4050 |
---|
6690 | % prints double-sided nicely when \bindingoffset=10mm and \hoffset=-6mm. |
---|
6691 | % To change the settings for a different printer or situation, adjust |
---|
6692 | % \normaloffset until the front-side and back-side texts align. Then |
---|
6693 | % do the same for \bindingoffset. You can set these for testing in |
---|
6694 | % your texinfo source file like this: |
---|
6695 | % @tex |
---|
6696 | % \global\normaloffset = -6mm |
---|
6697 | % \global\bindingoffset = 10mm |
---|
6698 | % @end tex |
---|
6699 | \internalpagesizes{51\baselineskip}{160mm} |
---|
6700 | {\voffset}{\hoffset}% |
---|
6701 | {\bindingoffset}{44pt}% |
---|
6702 | {297mm}{210mm}% |
---|
6703 | % |
---|
6704 | \tolerance = 700 |
---|
6705 | \hfuzz = 1pt |
---|
6706 | \contentsrightmargin = 0pt |
---|
6707 | \defbodyindent = 5mm |
---|
6708 | }} |
---|
6709 | |
---|
6710 | % Use @afivepaper to print on European A5 paper. |
---|
6711 | % From romildo@urano.iceb.ufop.br, 2 July 2000. |
---|
6712 | % He also recommends making @example and @lisp be small. |
---|
6713 | \def\afivepaper{{\globaldefs = 1 |
---|
6714 | \parskip = 2pt plus 1pt minus 0.1pt |
---|
6715 | \textleading = 12.5pt |
---|
6716 | % |
---|
6717 | \internalpagesizes{160mm}{120mm}% |
---|
6718 | {\voffset}{\hoffset}% |
---|
6719 | {\bindingoffset}{8pt}% |
---|
6720 | {210mm}{148mm}% |
---|
6721 | % |
---|
6722 | \lispnarrowing = 0.2in |
---|
6723 | \tolerance = 800 |
---|
6724 | \hfuzz = 1.2pt |
---|
6725 | \contentsrightmargin = 0pt |
---|
6726 | \defbodyindent = 2mm |
---|
6727 | \tableindent = 12mm |
---|
6728 | }} |
---|
6729 | |
---|
6730 | % A specific text layout, 24x15cm overall, intended for A4 paper. |
---|
6731 | \def\afourlatex{{\globaldefs = 1 |
---|
6732 | \afourpaper |
---|
6733 | \internalpagesizes{237mm}{150mm}% |
---|
6734 | {\voffset}{4.6mm}% |
---|
6735 | {\bindingoffset}{7mm}% |
---|
6736 | {297mm}{210mm}% |
---|
6737 | % |
---|
6738 | % Must explicitly reset to 0 because we call \afourpaper. |
---|
6739 | \globaldefs = 0 |
---|
6740 | }} |
---|
6741 | |
---|
6742 | % Use @afourwide to print on A4 paper in landscape format. |
---|
6743 | \def\afourwide{{\globaldefs = 1 |
---|
6744 | \afourpaper |
---|
6745 | \internalpagesizes{241mm}{165mm}% |
---|
6746 | {\voffset}{-2.95mm}% |
---|
6747 | {\bindingoffset}{7mm}% |
---|
6748 | {297mm}{210mm}% |
---|
6749 | \globaldefs = 0 |
---|
6750 | }} |
---|
6751 | |
---|
6752 | % @pagesizes TEXTHEIGHT[,TEXTWIDTH] |
---|
6753 | % Perhaps we should allow setting the margins, \topskip, \parskip, |
---|
6754 | % and/or leading, also. Or perhaps we should compute them somehow. |
---|
6755 | % |
---|
6756 | \parseargdef\pagesizes{\pagesizesyyy #1,,\finish} |
---|
6757 | \def\pagesizesyyy#1,#2,#3\finish{{% |
---|
6758 | \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \hsize=#2\relax \fi |
---|
6759 | \globaldefs = 1 |
---|
6760 | % |
---|
6761 | \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt |
---|
6762 | \setleading{\textleading}% |
---|
6763 | % |
---|
6764 | \dimen0 = #1 |
---|
6765 | \advance\dimen0 by \voffset |
---|
6766 | % |
---|
6767 | \dimen2 = \hsize |
---|
6768 | \advance\dimen2 by \normaloffset |
---|
6769 | % |
---|
6770 | \internalpagesizes{#1}{\hsize}% |
---|
6771 | {\voffset}{\normaloffset}% |
---|
6772 | {\bindingoffset}{44pt}% |
---|
6773 | {\dimen0}{\dimen2}% |
---|
6774 | }} |
---|
6775 | |
---|
6776 | % Set default to letter. |
---|
6777 | % |
---|
6778 | \letterpaper |
---|
6779 | |
---|
6780 | |
---|
6781 | \message{and turning on texinfo input format.} |
---|
6782 | |
---|
6783 | % Define macros to output various characters with catcode for normal text. |
---|
6784 | \catcode`\"=\other |
---|
6785 | \catcode`\~=\other |
---|
6786 | \catcode`\^=\other |
---|
6787 | \catcode`\_=\other |
---|
6788 | \catcode`\|=\other |
---|
6789 | \catcode`\<=\other |
---|
6790 | \catcode`\>=\other |
---|
6791 | \catcode`\+=\other |
---|
6792 | \catcode`\$=\other |
---|
6793 | \def\normaldoublequote{"} |
---|
6794 | \def\normaltilde{~} |
---|
6795 | \def\normalcaret{^} |
---|
6796 | \def\normalunderscore{_} |
---|
6797 | \def\normalverticalbar{|} |
---|
6798 | \def\normalless{<} |
---|
6799 | \def\normalgreater{>} |
---|
6800 | \def\normalplus{+} |
---|
6801 | \def\normaldollar{$}%$ font-lock fix |
---|
6802 | |
---|
6803 | % This macro is used to make a character print one way in \tt |
---|
6804 | % (where it can probably be output as-is), and another way in other fonts, |
---|
6805 | % where something hairier probably needs to be done. |
---|
6806 | % |
---|
6807 | % #1 is what to print if we are indeed using \tt; #2 is what to print |
---|
6808 | % otherwise. Since all the Computer Modern typewriter fonts have zero |
---|
6809 | % interword stretch (and shrink), and it is reasonable to expect all |
---|
6810 | % typewriter fonts to have this, we can check that font parameter. |
---|
6811 | % |
---|
6812 | \def\ifusingtt#1#2{\ifdim \fontdimen3\font=0pt #1\else #2\fi} |
---|
6813 | |
---|
6814 | % Same as above, but check for italic font. Actually this also catches |
---|
6815 | % non-italic slanted fonts since it is impossible to distinguish them from |
---|
6816 | % italic fonts. But since this is only used by $ and it uses \sl anyway |
---|
6817 | % this is not a problem. |
---|
6818 | \def\ifusingit#1#2{\ifdim \fontdimen1\font>0pt #1\else #2\fi} |
---|
6819 | |
---|
6820 | % Turn off all special characters except @ |
---|
6821 | % (and those which the user can use as if they were ordinary). |
---|
6822 | % Most of these we simply print from the \tt font, but for some, we can |
---|
6823 | % use math or other variants that look better in normal text. |
---|
6824 | |
---|
6825 | \catcode`\"=\active |
---|
6826 | \def\activedoublequote{{\tt\char34}} |
---|
6827 | \let"=\activedoublequote |
---|
6828 | \catcode`\~=\active |
---|
6829 | \def~{{\tt\char126}} |
---|
6830 | \chardef\hat=`\^ |
---|
6831 | \catcode`\^=\active |
---|
6832 | \def^{{\tt \hat}} |
---|
6833 | |
---|
6834 | \catcode`\_=\active |
---|
6835 | \def_{\ifusingtt\normalunderscore\_} |
---|
6836 | % Subroutine for the previous macro. |
---|
6837 | \def\_{\leavevmode \kern.07em \vbox{\hrule width.3em height.1ex}\kern .07em } |
---|
6838 | |
---|
6839 | \catcode`\|=\active |
---|
6840 | \def|{{\tt\char124}} |
---|
6841 | \chardef \less=`\< |
---|
6842 | \catcode`\<=\active |
---|
6843 | \def<{{\tt \less}} |
---|
6844 | \chardef \gtr=`\> |
---|
6845 | \catcode`\>=\active |
---|
6846 | \def>{{\tt \gtr}} |
---|
6847 | \catcode`\+=\active |
---|
6848 | \def+{{\tt \char 43}} |
---|
6849 | \catcode`\$=\active |
---|
6850 | \def${\ifusingit{{\sl\$}}\normaldollar}%$ font-lock fix |
---|
6851 | |
---|
6852 | % If a .fmt file is being used, characters that might appear in a file |
---|
6853 | % name cannot be active until we have parsed the command line. |
---|
6854 | % So turn them off again, and have \everyjob (or @setfilename) turn them on. |
---|
6855 | % \otherifyactive is called near the end of this file. |
---|
6856 | \def\otherifyactive{\catcode`+=\other \catcode`\_=\other} |
---|
6857 | |
---|
6858 | \catcode`\@=0 |
---|
6859 | |
---|
6860 | % \backslashcurfont outputs one backslash character in current font, |
---|
6861 | % as in \char`\\. |
---|
6862 | \global\chardef\backslashcurfont=`\\ |
---|
6863 | \global\let\rawbackslashxx=\backslashcurfont % let existing .??s files work |
---|
6864 | |
---|
6865 | % \rawbackslash defines an active \ to do \backslashcurfont. |
---|
6866 | % \otherbackslash defines an active \ to be a literal `\' character with |
---|
6867 | % catcode other. |
---|
6868 | {\catcode`\\=\active |
---|
6869 | @gdef@rawbackslash{@let\=@backslashcurfont} |
---|
6870 | @gdef@otherbackslash{@let\=@realbackslash} |
---|
6871 | } |
---|
6872 | |
---|
6873 | % \realbackslash is an actual character `\' with catcode other. |
---|
6874 | {\catcode`\\=\other @gdef@realbackslash{\}} |
---|
6875 | |
---|
6876 | % \normalbackslash outputs one backslash in fixed width font. |
---|
6877 | \def\normalbackslash{{\tt\backslashcurfont}} |
---|
6878 | |
---|
6879 | \catcode`\\=\active |
---|
6880 | |
---|
6881 | % Used sometimes to turn off (effectively) the active characters |
---|
6882 | % even after parsing them. |
---|
6883 | @def@turnoffactive{% |
---|
6884 | @let"=@normaldoublequote |
---|
6885 | @let\=@realbackslash |
---|
6886 | @let~=@normaltilde |
---|
6887 | @let^=@normalcaret |
---|
6888 | @let_=@normalunderscore |
---|
6889 | @let|=@normalverticalbar |
---|
6890 | @let<=@normalless |
---|
6891 | @let>=@normalgreater |
---|
6892 | @let+=@normalplus |
---|
6893 | @let$=@normaldollar %$ font-lock fix |
---|
6894 | @unsepspaces |
---|
6895 | } |
---|
6896 | |
---|
6897 | % Same as @turnoffactive except outputs \ as {\tt\char`\\} instead of |
---|
6898 | % the literal character `\'. (Thus, \ is not expandable when this is in |
---|
6899 | % effect.) |
---|
6900 | % |
---|
6901 | @def@normalturnoffactive{@turnoffactive @let\=@normalbackslash} |
---|
6902 | |
---|
6903 | % Make _ and + \other characters, temporarily. |
---|
6904 | % This is canceled by @fixbackslash. |
---|
6905 | @otherifyactive |
---|
6906 | |
---|
6907 | % If a .fmt file is being used, we don't want the `\input texinfo' to show up. |
---|
6908 | % That is what \eatinput is for; after that, the `\' should revert to printing |
---|
6909 | % a backslash. |
---|
6910 | % |
---|
6911 | @gdef@eatinput input texinfo{@fixbackslash} |
---|
6912 | @global@let\ = @eatinput |
---|
6913 | |
---|
6914 | % On the other hand, perhaps the file did not have a `\input texinfo'. Then |
---|
6915 | % the first `\{ in the file would cause an error. This macro tries to fix |
---|
6916 | % that, assuming it is called before the first `\' could plausibly occur. |
---|
6917 | % Also back turn on active characters that might appear in the input |
---|
6918 | % file name, in case not using a pre-dumped format. |
---|
6919 | % |
---|
6920 | @gdef@fixbackslash{% |
---|
6921 | @ifx\@eatinput @let\ = @normalbackslash @fi |
---|
6922 | @catcode`+=@active |
---|
6923 | @catcode`@_=@active |
---|
6924 | } |
---|
6925 | |
---|
6926 | % Say @foo, not \foo, in error messages. |
---|
6927 | @escapechar = `@@ |
---|
6928 | |
---|
6929 | % These look ok in all fonts, so just make them not special. |
---|
6930 | @catcode`@& = @other |
---|
6931 | @catcode`@# = @other |
---|
6932 | @catcode`@% = @other |
---|
6933 | |
---|
6934 | |
---|
6935 | @c Local variables: |
---|
6936 | @c eval: (add-hook 'write-file-hooks 'time-stamp) |
---|
6937 | @c page-delimiter: "^\\\\message" |
---|
6938 | @c time-stamp-start: "def\\\\texinfoversion{" |
---|
6939 | @c time-stamp-format: "%:y-%02m-%02d.%02H" |
---|
6940 | @c time-stamp-end: "}" |
---|
6941 | @c End: |
---|
6942 | |
---|
6943 | @c vim:sw=2: |
---|
6944 | |
---|
6945 | @ignore |
---|
6946 | arch-tag: e1b36e32-c96e-4135-a41a-0b2efa2ea115 |
---|
6947 | @end ignore |
---|